Use bool for boolean in xterm.c
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob8cc6475de5378833bd268330830aab90441a2898
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include "lisp.h"
27 #include "blockinput.h"
28 #include "syssignal.h"
30 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
31 if this is not done before the other system files. */
32 #include "xterm.h"
33 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
35 /* If we have Xfixes extension, use it for pointer blanking. */
36 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
37 #include <X11/extensions/Xfixes.h>
38 #endif
40 /* Using Xft implies that XRender is available. */
41 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
42 #include <X11/extensions/Xrender.h>
43 #endif
45 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
46 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
47 #ifndef makedev
48 #include <sys/types.h>
49 #endif /* makedev */
51 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
53 #include "systime.h"
55 #include <fcntl.h>
56 #include <errno.h>
57 #include <sys/stat.h>
58 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
59 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
61 #include "charset.h"
62 #include "character.h"
63 #include "coding.h"
64 #include "frame.h"
65 #include "dispextern.h"
66 #include "fontset.h"
67 #include "termhooks.h"
68 #include "termopts.h"
69 #include "termchar.h"
70 #include "emacs-icon.h"
71 #include "disptab.h"
72 #include "buffer.h"
73 #include "window.h"
74 #include "keyboard.h"
75 #include "intervals.h"
76 #include "process.h"
77 #include "atimer.h"
78 #include "keymap.h"
79 #include "font.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83 #include "menu.h"
85 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
86 #include <X11/Shell.h>
87 #endif
89 #include <unistd.h>
91 #ifdef USE_GTK
92 #include "gtkutil.h"
93 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
94 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
95 #endif
96 #endif
98 #if defined (USE_LUCID) || defined (USE_MOTIF)
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* For LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
139 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
141 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
142 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
143 #endif
145 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
146 #ifdef USE_XIM
147 bool use_xim = true;
148 #else
149 bool use_xim = false; /* configure --without-xim */
150 #endif
152 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
153 start. */
155 static bool any_help_event_p;
157 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
158 use. */
160 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
162 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
164 /* The application context for Xt use. */
165 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
166 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
168 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
169 static bool toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
171 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
173 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
174 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
175 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
177 static Time ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
179 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
181 static int x_noop_count;
183 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
185 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
186 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
188 #ifdef USE_GTK
189 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
190 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
192 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
193 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
194 #endif
196 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
197 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
199 enum xembed_info
201 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
204 enum xembed_message
206 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
207 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
208 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
209 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
210 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
211 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
212 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
213 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
215 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
216 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
217 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
218 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
219 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
222 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
223 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, bool, int, int, bool);
224 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
225 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
226 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
227 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
228 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
229 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
230 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
231 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
232 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
233 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
234 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
235 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
236 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
237 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
238 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
239 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
240 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
241 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
242 enum text_cursor_kinds);
244 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
245 enum glyph_row_area, GC);
246 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
247 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
248 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
249 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window, int);
250 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
251 enum scroll_bar_part *,
252 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
253 Time *);
254 static void x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
255 enum scroll_bar_part *,
256 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
257 Time *);
258 static bool x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, const XPropertyEvent *);
259 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
260 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
261 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, bool);
262 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *,
263 const XEvent *, int *,
264 struct input_event *);
265 #if ! (defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_MOTIF)
266 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
267 #endif
268 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
269 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
270 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
271 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
272 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
273 static void x_initialize (void);
275 static bool get_current_wm_state (struct frame *, Window, int *, bool *);
277 /* Flush display of frame F. */
279 static void
280 x_flush (struct frame *f)
282 eassert (f && FRAME_X_P (f));
283 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
284 connection may be broken. */
285 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
286 return;
288 block_input ();
289 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
290 unblock_input ();
294 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
295 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
296 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
297 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
298 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
299 performance. */
301 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
304 /***********************************************************************
305 Debugging
306 ***********************************************************************/
308 #if false
310 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
311 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
313 struct record
315 char *locus;
316 int type;
319 struct record event_record[100];
321 int event_record_index;
323 void
324 record_event (char *locus, int type)
326 if (event_record_index == ARRAYELTS (event_record))
327 event_record_index = 0;
329 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
330 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
331 event_record_index++;
334 #endif
338 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
340 struct x_display_info *
341 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
343 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
345 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
346 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
347 return dpyinfo;
349 return 0;
352 static Window
353 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
355 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
356 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
357 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
359 while (wi != FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
361 Window root;
362 Window *children;
363 unsigned int nchildren;
365 win = wi;
366 if (XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren))
367 XFree (children);
368 else
369 break;
372 return win;
375 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
377 void
378 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
380 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
381 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
382 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
383 double alpha = 1.0;
384 double alpha_min = 1.0;
385 unsigned long opac;
386 Window parent;
388 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
389 alpha = f->alpha[0];
390 else
391 alpha = f->alpha[1];
393 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
394 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
395 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
396 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
398 if (alpha < 0.0)
399 return;
400 else if (alpha > 1.0)
401 alpha = 1.0;
402 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
403 alpha = alpha_min;
405 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
407 x_catch_errors (dpy);
409 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
410 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
411 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
412 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
414 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
415 if (parent != None)
416 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
417 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
418 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1);
420 /* return unless necessary */
422 unsigned char *data;
423 Atom actual;
424 int rc, format;
425 unsigned long n, left;
427 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
428 0, 1, False, XA_CARDINAL,
429 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
430 &data);
432 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
434 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
435 XFree (data);
436 if (value == opac)
438 x_uncatch_errors ();
439 return;
444 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
445 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
446 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1);
447 x_uncatch_errors ();
450 /***********************************************************************
451 Starting and ending an update
452 ***********************************************************************/
454 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
455 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
456 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
457 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
458 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
460 static void
461 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
463 /* Nothing to do. */
467 /* Start update of window W. */
469 static void
470 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
472 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
473 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
475 w->output_cursor = w->cursor;
477 block_input ();
479 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
481 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
482 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = true;
484 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
485 highlighting. */
486 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
487 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
490 unblock_input ();
494 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
496 static void
497 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
499 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
500 struct face *face;
502 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
503 if (face)
504 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
505 face->foreground);
507 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
508 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
511 /* Draw a window divider from (x0,y0) to (x1,y1) */
513 static void
514 x_draw_window_divider (struct window *w, int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
516 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
517 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FACE_ID);
518 struct face *face_first = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FIRST_PIXEL_FACE_ID);
519 struct face *face_last = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_LAST_PIXEL_FACE_ID);
520 unsigned long color = face ? face->foreground : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f);
521 unsigned long color_first = (face_first
522 ? face_first->foreground
523 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
524 unsigned long color_last = (face_last
525 ? face_last->foreground
526 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
527 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
528 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
530 if (y1 - y0 > x1 - x0 && x1 - x0 > 2)
531 /* Vertical. */
533 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_first);
534 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
535 x0, y0, 1, y1 - y0);
536 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
537 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
538 x0 + 1, y0, x1 - x0 - 2, y1 - y0);
539 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_last);
540 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
541 x1 - 1, y0, 1, y1 - y0);
543 else if (x1 - x0 > y1 - y0 && y1 - y0 > 3)
544 /* Horizontal. */
546 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_first);
547 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
548 x0, y0, x1 - x0, 1);
549 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
550 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
551 x0, y0 + 1, x1 - x0, y1 - y0 - 2);
552 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_last);
553 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
554 x0, y1 - 1, x1 - x0, 1);
556 else
558 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
559 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
560 x0, y0, x1 - x0, y1 - y0);
564 /* End update of window W.
566 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
567 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
569 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
570 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
571 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
573 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
574 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
575 here. */
577 static void
578 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, bool cursor_on_p,
579 bool mouse_face_overwritten_p)
581 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
583 block_input ();
585 if (cursor_on_p)
586 display_and_set_cursor (w, true,
587 w->output_cursor.hpos, w->output_cursor.vpos,
588 w->output_cursor.x, w->output_cursor.y);
590 if (draw_window_fringes (w, true))
592 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
593 x_draw_right_divider (w);
594 else
595 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
598 unblock_input ();
601 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
602 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
603 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
605 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
607 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
608 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
609 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
614 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
615 update_end. */
617 static void
618 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
620 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
621 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = false;
623 #ifndef XFlush
624 block_input ();
625 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
626 unblock_input ();
627 #endif
631 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c
632 whenever a complete update has been performed. */
634 static void
635 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
637 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
638 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
642 /* Clear under internal border if any (GTK has its own version). */
643 #ifndef USE_GTK
644 void
645 x_clear_under_internal_border (struct frame *f)
647 if (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f) > 0)
649 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
650 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
651 int border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
652 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
653 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
654 int margin = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f);
656 block_input ();
657 x_clear_area (display, window, 0, 0, border, height);
658 x_clear_area (display, window, 0, margin, width, border);
659 x_clear_area (display, window, width - border, 0, border, height);
660 x_clear_area (display, window, 0, height - border, width, border);
661 unblock_input ();
664 #endif
666 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
667 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
668 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. This function is called from
669 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
670 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
672 static void
673 x_after_update_window_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *desired_row)
675 eassert (w);
677 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
678 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = true;
680 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
681 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
682 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
683 check here if updated window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
684 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
685 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
686 overhead is very small. */
688 struct frame *f;
689 int width, height;
691 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
692 && desired_row->full_width_p
693 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
694 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
695 width != 0)
696 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
697 height > 0))
699 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
701 block_input ();
702 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
703 0, y, width, height);
704 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
705 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
706 y, width, height);
707 unblock_input ();
710 #endif
713 static void
714 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
716 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
717 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
718 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
719 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
720 struct face *face = p->face;
722 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
723 x_clip_to_row (w, row, ANY_AREA, gc);
725 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
727 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
728 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
729 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
730 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
731 if (face->stipple)
732 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
733 else
734 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
736 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
737 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
739 if (!face->stipple)
740 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
743 if (p->which)
745 char *bits;
746 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
747 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
748 XGCValues gcv;
750 if (p->wd > 8)
751 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
752 else
753 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
755 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
756 by the server. */
757 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
758 (p->cursor_p
759 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
760 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
761 : face->foreground),
762 face->background, depth);
764 if (p->overlay_p)
766 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
767 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
768 bits, p->wd, p->h,
769 1, 0, 1);
770 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
771 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
772 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
773 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
776 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
777 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
778 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
780 if (p->overlay_p)
782 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
783 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
784 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
788 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
791 /***********************************************************************
792 Glyph display
793 ***********************************************************************/
797 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
798 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
799 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
800 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
801 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
802 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
803 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
804 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
805 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
806 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
807 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
808 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
809 unsigned long *, double, int);
810 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
811 double, int, unsigned long);
812 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
813 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
814 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
815 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
816 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
817 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
818 int, int, int);
819 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
820 int, bool, bool, bool, bool, bool,
821 XRectangle *);
822 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
823 int, bool, bool, XRectangle *);
824 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
826 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
827 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
828 #endif
831 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
832 face. */
834 static void
835 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
837 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
838 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
839 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
840 && !s->cmp)
841 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
842 else
844 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
845 XGCValues xgcv;
846 unsigned long mask;
848 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
849 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
851 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
852 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
853 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
854 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
855 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
856 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
857 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
859 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
860 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
861 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
863 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
864 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
867 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
868 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
869 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
871 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
872 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
873 mask, &xgcv);
874 else
875 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
876 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
878 s->gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
883 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
885 static void
886 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
888 int face_id;
889 struct face *face;
891 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
892 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
893 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
894 if (face == NULL)
895 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
897 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
898 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
899 else
900 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
901 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
902 prepare_face_for_display (s->f, s->face);
904 if (s->font == s->face->font)
905 s->gc = s->face->gc;
906 else
908 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
909 except for FONT. */
910 XGCValues xgcv;
911 unsigned long mask;
913 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
914 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
915 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
916 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
918 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
919 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
920 mask, &xgcv);
921 else
922 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
923 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
925 s->gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
928 eassert (s->gc != 0);
932 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
933 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
934 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
936 static void
937 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
939 s->gc = s->face->gc;
943 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
944 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
945 pattern. */
947 static void
948 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
950 prepare_face_for_display (s->f, s->face);
952 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
954 s->gc = s->face->gc;
955 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
957 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
959 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
960 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
962 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
964 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
965 s->stippled_p = false;
967 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
969 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
970 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
972 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
973 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
975 s->gc = s->face->gc;
976 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
978 else
979 emacs_abort ();
981 /* GC must have been set. */
982 eassert (s->gc != 0);
986 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
987 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
989 static void
990 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
992 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
993 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
995 if (n > 0)
996 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
997 s->num_clips = n;
1001 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1002 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1003 the area of SRC. */
1005 static void
1006 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1008 XRectangle r;
1010 r.x = src->x;
1011 r.width = src->width;
1012 r.y = src->y;
1013 r.height = src->height;
1014 dst->clip[0] = r;
1015 dst->num_clips = 1;
1016 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1020 /* RIF:
1021 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1023 static void
1024 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1026 if (s->cmp == NULL
1027 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1028 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1030 struct font_metrics metrics;
1032 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1034 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1035 struct font *font = s->font;
1036 int i;
1038 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1039 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1040 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1042 else
1044 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1046 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1048 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1049 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1050 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1052 else if (s->cmp)
1054 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1055 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1060 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1062 static void
1063 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1065 XGCValues xgcv;
1066 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1067 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1068 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1069 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1073 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1074 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1075 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1076 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1077 contains the first component of a composition. */
1079 static void
1080 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, bool force_p)
1082 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1083 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1084 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1086 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1088 if (s->stippled_p)
1090 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1091 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1093 s->y + box_line_width,
1094 s->background_width,
1095 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1096 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1097 s->background_filled_p = true;
1099 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1100 || s->font_not_found_p
1101 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1102 || force_p)
1104 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1105 s->background_width,
1106 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1107 s->background_filled_p = true;
1113 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1115 static void
1116 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1118 int i, x;
1120 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1121 of S to the right of that box line. */
1122 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1123 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1124 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1125 else
1126 x = s->x;
1128 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1129 loaded. */
1130 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1132 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1134 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1135 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1136 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1137 s->height - 1);
1138 x += g->pixel_width;
1141 else
1143 struct font *font = s->font;
1144 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1145 int y;
1147 if (font->vertical_centering)
1148 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1150 y = s->ybase - boff;
1151 if (s->for_overlaps
1152 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1153 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, false);
1154 else
1155 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, true);
1156 if (s->face->overstrike)
1157 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, false);
1161 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1163 static void
1164 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1166 int i, j, x;
1167 struct font *font = s->font;
1169 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1170 of S to the right of that box line. */
1171 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1172 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1173 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1174 else
1175 x = s->x;
1177 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1178 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1179 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1180 this composition. */
1182 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1183 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1184 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1186 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1187 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1188 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1190 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1192 int y = s->ybase;
1194 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1195 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1196 space on the left or right. */
1197 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1199 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1200 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1202 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, false);
1203 if (s->face->overstrike)
1204 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, false);
1207 else
1209 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1210 Lisp_Object glyph;
1211 int y = s->ybase;
1212 int width = 0;
1214 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1216 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1217 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1218 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1219 else
1221 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1223 if (j < i)
1225 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, false);
1226 if (s->face->overstrike)
1227 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, false);
1228 x += width;
1230 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1231 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1232 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1233 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, false);
1234 if (s->face->overstrike)
1235 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff,
1236 false);
1237 x += wadjust;
1238 j = i + 1;
1239 width = 0;
1242 if (j < i)
1244 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, false);
1245 if (s->face->overstrike)
1246 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, false);
1252 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1254 static void
1255 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1257 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1258 XChar2b char2b[8];
1259 int x, i, j;
1261 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1262 of S to the right of that box line. */
1263 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1264 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1265 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1266 else
1267 x = s->x;
1269 s->char2b = char2b;
1271 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1273 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1274 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1276 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1278 if (len > 0
1279 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1280 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1281 >= 1))
1283 Lisp_Object acronym
1284 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1285 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1286 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1287 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1288 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1289 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1292 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1294 sprintf (buf, "%0*X",
1295 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1296 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1297 str = buf;
1300 if (str)
1302 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1303 unsigned code;
1305 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1306 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1308 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1309 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1311 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1312 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1313 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1314 false);
1315 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1316 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1317 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1318 false);
1320 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1321 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1322 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1323 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1324 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1325 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1329 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1331 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1333 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1334 cannot be determined. */
1336 static struct frame *
1337 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1339 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1340 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1341 struct frame *f;
1343 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1345 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1346 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1347 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1348 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1349 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1350 widget = XtParent (widget);
1352 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1353 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1354 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1356 f = XFRAME (frame);
1357 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1358 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1359 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1360 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1361 return f;
1363 emacs_abort ();
1366 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1367 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1368 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1369 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1370 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1371 Value is true if successful. */
1373 bool
1374 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1375 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1377 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1378 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1381 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1384 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1385 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1387 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1389 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1390 sizeof (Screen *)},
1391 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1392 sizeof (Colormap)}
1396 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1397 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1399 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1402 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1404 DPY is the display we are working on.
1406 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1407 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1408 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1409 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1411 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1412 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1414 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1415 we allocated the color or not.
1417 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1419 static Boolean
1420 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1421 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1422 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1424 Screen *screen;
1425 Colormap cmap;
1426 Pixel pixel;
1427 String color_name;
1428 XColor color;
1430 if (*nargs != 2)
1432 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1433 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1434 "XtToolkitError",
1435 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1436 return False;
1439 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1440 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1441 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1443 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1445 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1446 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1448 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1450 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1451 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1453 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1454 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1456 pixel = color.pixel;
1457 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1459 else
1461 String params[1];
1462 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1464 params[0] = color_name;
1465 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1466 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1467 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1468 params, &nparams);
1469 return False;
1472 if (to->addr != NULL)
1474 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1476 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1477 return False;
1480 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1482 else
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1485 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1488 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1489 return True;
1493 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1494 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1495 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1497 APP is the application context in which we work.
1499 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1500 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1501 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1503 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1505 static void
1506 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1507 Cardinal *nargs)
1509 if (*nargs != 2)
1511 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1512 "XtToolkitError",
1513 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1514 NULL, NULL);
1516 else if (closure != NULL)
1518 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1519 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1520 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1521 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1522 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1527 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1530 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1531 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1532 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1533 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1535 static const XColor *
1536 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1538 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1540 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1542 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1543 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1544 int i;
1546 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1547 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1548 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1550 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1551 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1553 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1554 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1557 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1558 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1562 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1563 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1565 void
1566 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1568 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1570 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1572 int i;
1573 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1575 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1576 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1577 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1578 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1581 else
1582 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1586 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1587 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1589 void
1590 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1592 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1596 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1597 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1598 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1599 allocated. */
1601 static bool
1602 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1604 bool rc;
1606 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1607 if (rc == 0)
1609 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1610 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1611 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1612 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1613 int nearest, i;
1614 int max_color_delta = 255;
1615 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1616 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1617 int ncells;
1618 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1620 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1622 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1623 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1624 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1625 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1627 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1629 nearest = i;
1630 nearest_delta = delta;
1634 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1635 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1636 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1637 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1639 else
1641 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1642 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1643 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1644 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1645 XColor *cached_color;
1647 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1648 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1649 (cached_color->red != color->red
1650 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1651 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1653 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1654 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1655 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1659 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1660 if (rc)
1661 register_color (color->pixel);
1662 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1664 return rc;
1668 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1669 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1670 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1671 allocated. */
1673 bool
1674 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1676 gamma_correct (f, color);
1677 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1681 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1682 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1683 get color reference counts right. */
1685 unsigned long
1686 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, unsigned long pixel)
1688 XColor color;
1690 color.pixel = pixel;
1691 block_input ();
1692 x_query_color (f, &color);
1693 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1694 unblock_input ();
1695 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1696 register_color (pixel);
1697 #endif
1698 return color.pixel;
1702 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1703 boosted.
1705 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1706 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1707 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1708 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1709 use an additional additive factor.
1711 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1712 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1713 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1716 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1717 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1718 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1719 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1720 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1721 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1723 static bool
1724 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1725 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1727 XColor color, new;
1728 long bright;
1729 bool success_p;
1731 /* Get RGB color values. */
1732 color.pixel = *pixel;
1733 x_query_color (f, &color);
1735 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1736 eassert (factor >= 0);
1737 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1738 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1739 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1741 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1742 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1744 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1745 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1746 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1747 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1748 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1750 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1751 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1752 /* The additive adjustment. */
1753 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1755 if (factor < 1)
1757 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1758 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1759 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1761 else
1763 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1764 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1765 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1769 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1770 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1771 if (success_p)
1773 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1775 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1776 delta to the RGB values. */
1777 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1779 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1780 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1781 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1782 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1784 else
1785 success_p = true;
1786 *pixel = new.pixel;
1789 return success_p;
1793 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1794 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1795 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1796 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1797 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1798 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1800 static void
1801 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor,
1802 int delta, unsigned long default_pixel)
1804 XGCValues xgcv;
1805 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1806 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1807 unsigned long pixel;
1808 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1809 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1810 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1811 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1813 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1814 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1816 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1817 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1818 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1819 if (relief->gc && relief->pixel != -1)
1821 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1822 relief->pixel = -1;
1825 /* Allocate new color. */
1826 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1827 pixel = background;
1828 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1829 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1830 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1832 if (relief->gc == 0)
1834 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1835 mask |= GCStipple;
1836 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1838 else
1839 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1843 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1845 static void
1846 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1848 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1849 unsigned long color;
1851 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1852 color = s->face->box_color;
1853 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1854 && s->img->pixmap
1855 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1856 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1857 else
1859 XGCValues xgcv;
1861 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1862 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1863 color = xgcv.background;
1866 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1867 || color != di->relief_background)
1869 di->relief_background = color;
1870 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1871 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1872 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1873 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1878 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1879 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1880 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P means draw a raised
1881 relief. LEFT_P means draw a relief on the left side of
1882 the rectangle. RIGHT_P means draw a relief on the right
1883 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1884 when drawing. */
1886 static void
1887 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1888 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y,
1889 int width, bool raised_p, bool top_p, bool bot_p,
1890 bool left_p, bool right_p,
1891 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1893 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1894 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1895 int i;
1896 GC gc;
1898 if (raised_p)
1899 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1900 else
1901 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1902 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1904 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1905 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1906 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1907 corner pixels. */
1909 /* Top. */
1910 if (top_p)
1912 if (width == 1)
1913 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1914 left_x + left_p, top_y,
1915 right_x + !right_p, top_y);
1917 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
1918 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1919 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
1920 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
1923 /* Left. */
1924 if (left_p)
1926 if (width == 1)
1927 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
1929 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
1930 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
1932 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
1933 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1934 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
1935 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
1938 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1939 if (raised_p)
1940 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1941 else
1942 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1943 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1945 if (width > 1)
1947 /* Outermost top line. */
1948 if (top_p)
1949 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1950 left_x + left_p, top_y,
1951 right_x + !right_p, top_y);
1953 /* Outermost left line. */
1954 if (left_p)
1955 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
1958 /* Bottom. */
1959 if (bot_p)
1961 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1962 left_x + left_p, bottom_y,
1963 right_x + !right_p, bottom_y);
1964 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
1965 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1966 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
1967 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
1970 /* Right. */
1971 if (right_p)
1973 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
1974 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
1975 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1976 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1977 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
1978 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
1981 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1985 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
1986 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
1987 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P means draw a line on the
1988 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P means draw a line
1989 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
1990 rectangle to use when drawing. */
1992 static void
1993 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
1994 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1995 bool left_p, bool right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
1997 XGCValues xgcv;
1999 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2000 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2001 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2003 /* Top. */
2004 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2005 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2007 /* Left. */
2008 if (left_p)
2009 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2010 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2012 /* Bottom. */
2013 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2014 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2016 /* Right. */
2017 if (right_p)
2018 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2019 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2021 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2022 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2026 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2028 static void
2029 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2031 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x;
2032 bool raised_p, left_p, right_p;
2033 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2034 XRectangle clip_rect;
2036 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2037 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2038 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2040 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2041 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2042 ? s->first_glyph
2043 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2045 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2046 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2047 left_x = s->x;
2048 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2049 ? last_x - 1
2050 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2051 top_y = s->y;
2052 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2054 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2055 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2056 && (s->prev == NULL
2057 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2058 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2059 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2060 && (s->next == NULL
2061 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2063 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2065 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2066 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2067 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2068 else
2070 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2071 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2072 width, raised_p, true, true, left_p, right_p,
2073 &clip_rect);
2078 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2080 static void
2081 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2083 int x = s->x;
2084 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2086 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2087 right of that line. */
2088 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2089 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2090 && s->slice.x == 0)
2091 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2093 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2094 by that margin. */
2095 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2096 x += s->img->hmargin;
2097 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2098 y += s->img->vmargin;
2100 if (s->img->pixmap)
2102 if (s->img->mask)
2104 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2105 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2106 trust on the shape extension to be available
2107 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2108 manually. */
2109 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2110 | GCFunction);
2111 XGCValues xgcv;
2112 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2114 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2115 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2116 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2117 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2118 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2120 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2121 image_rect.x = x;
2122 image_rect.y = y;
2123 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2124 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2125 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2126 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2127 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2128 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2130 else
2132 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2134 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2135 image_rect.x = x;
2136 image_rect.y = y;
2137 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2138 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2139 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2140 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2141 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2142 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2144 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2145 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2146 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2147 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2148 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2149 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2150 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2152 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2153 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2154 x - relief, y - relief,
2155 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2156 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2160 else
2161 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2162 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2163 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2167 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2169 static void
2170 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2172 int x1, y1, thick;
2173 bool raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2174 int extra_x, extra_y;
2175 XRectangle r;
2176 int x = s->x;
2177 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2179 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2180 right of that line. */
2181 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2182 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2183 && s->slice.x == 0)
2184 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2186 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2187 by that margin. */
2188 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2189 x += s->img->hmargin;
2190 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2191 y += s->img->vmargin;
2193 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2194 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2196 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2197 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2199 else
2201 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2202 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2205 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2206 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2208 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2209 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2211 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2212 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2213 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2215 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2216 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2218 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2219 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2222 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = false;
2224 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2225 x -= thick + extra_x, left_p = true;
2226 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2227 y -= thick + extra_y, top_p = true;
2228 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2229 x1 += thick + extra_x, right_p = true;
2230 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2231 y1 += thick + extra_y, bot_p = true;
2233 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2234 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2235 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2236 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2240 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2242 static void
2243 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2245 int x = 0;
2246 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2248 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2249 right of that line. */
2250 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2251 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2252 && s->slice.x == 0)
2253 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2255 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2256 by that margin. */
2257 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2258 x += s->img->hmargin;
2259 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2260 y += s->img->vmargin;
2262 if (s->img->pixmap)
2264 if (s->img->mask)
2266 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2267 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2268 trust on the shape extension to be available
2269 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2270 manually. */
2271 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2272 | GCFunction);
2273 XGCValues xgcv;
2275 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2276 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2277 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2278 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2279 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2281 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2282 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2283 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2284 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2286 else
2288 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2289 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2290 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2292 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2293 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2294 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2295 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2296 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2297 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2298 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2300 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2301 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2302 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2303 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2307 else
2308 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2309 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2310 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2314 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2315 give the rectangle to draw. */
2317 static void
2318 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2320 if (s->stippled_p)
2322 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2323 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2324 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2325 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2327 else
2328 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2332 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2334 s->y
2335 s->x +-------------------------
2336 | s->face->box
2338 | +-------------------------
2339 | | s->img->margin
2341 | | +-------------------
2342 | | | the image
2346 static void
2347 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2349 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2350 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2351 int height;
2352 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2354 height = s->height;
2355 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2356 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2357 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2358 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2360 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2361 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2362 flickering. */
2363 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2364 if (height > s->slice.height
2365 || s->img->hmargin
2366 || s->img->vmargin
2367 || s->img->mask
2368 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2369 || s->width != s->background_width)
2371 if (s->img->mask)
2373 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2374 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2375 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2376 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2377 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2379 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2380 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2381 s->background_width,
2382 s->height, depth);
2384 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2385 pixmap. */
2386 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2388 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2389 if (s->stippled_p)
2391 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2392 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2393 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2394 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2395 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2396 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2397 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2399 else
2401 XGCValues xgcv;
2402 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2403 &xgcv);
2404 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2405 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2406 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2407 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2410 else
2412 int x = s->x;
2413 int y = s->y;
2414 int width = s->background_width;
2416 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2417 && s->slice.x == 0)
2419 x += box_line_hwidth;
2420 width -= box_line_hwidth;
2423 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2424 y += box_line_vwidth;
2426 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, width, height);
2429 s->background_filled_p = true;
2432 /* Draw the foreground. */
2433 if (pixmap != None)
2435 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2436 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2437 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2438 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2439 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2441 else
2442 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2444 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2445 if (s->img->relief
2446 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2447 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2448 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2452 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2454 static void
2455 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2457 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2459 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2460 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2462 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2463 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2464 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2465 int x = s->x;
2467 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2469 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2471 if (x < left_x)
2473 background_width -= left_x - x;
2474 x = left_x;
2477 else
2479 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2480 stretch glyph. */
2481 int right_x = window_box_right (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2483 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2484 background_width -= x - right_x;
2485 x += background_width;
2487 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2488 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2489 x -= width;
2491 /* Draw cursor. */
2492 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2494 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2495 if (width < background_width)
2497 int y = s->y;
2498 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2499 XRectangle r;
2500 GC gc;
2502 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2503 x += width;
2504 else
2505 x = s->x;
2506 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2507 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2509 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2510 gc = s->gc;
2512 else
2513 gc = s->face->gc;
2515 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2516 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2518 if (s->face->stipple)
2520 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2521 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2522 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2523 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2525 else
2527 XGCValues xgcv;
2528 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2529 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2530 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2531 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2534 XSetClipMask (s->display, gc, None);
2537 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2539 int background_width = s->background_width;
2540 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2542 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2543 except for header line and mode line. */
2544 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2546 background_width -= left_x - x;
2547 x = left_x;
2549 if (background_width > 0)
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2553 s->background_filled_p = true;
2557 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2559 x0 wave_length = 2
2561 y0 * * * * *
2562 |* * * * * * * * *
2563 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2567 static void
2568 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2570 int wave_height = 3, wave_length = 2;
2571 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, xmax;
2572 bool odd;
2573 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2575 dx = wave_length;
2576 dy = wave_height - 1;
2577 x0 = s->x;
2578 y0 = s->ybase - wave_height + 3;
2579 width = s->width;
2580 xmax = x0 + width;
2582 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2584 wave_clip.x = x0;
2585 wave_clip.y = y0;
2586 wave_clip.width = width;
2587 wave_clip.height = wave_height;
2588 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2590 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2591 return;
2593 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2595 /* Draw the waves */
2597 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2598 x2 = x1 + dx;
2599 odd = (x1 / dx) & 1;
2600 y1 = y2 = y0;
2602 if (odd)
2603 y1 += dy;
2604 else
2605 y2 += dy;
2607 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2608 emacs_abort ();
2610 while (x1 <= xmax)
2612 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2613 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2614 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2615 odd = !odd;
2618 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2619 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2623 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2625 static void
2626 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2628 bool relief_drawn_p = false;
2630 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2631 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2632 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2633 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2635 int width;
2636 struct glyph_string *next;
2638 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2639 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2640 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2641 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2643 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2644 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2645 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2646 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2647 else
2648 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, true);
2649 next->num_clips = 0;
2653 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2654 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2656 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2657 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2658 if (!s->for_overlaps
2659 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2660 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2661 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2664 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2665 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, true);
2666 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2667 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2668 relief_drawn_p = true;
2670 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2671 && !s->clip_tail
2672 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2673 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2674 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2675 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2676 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2677 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2678 else
2679 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2681 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2683 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2684 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2685 break;
2687 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2688 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2689 break;
2691 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2692 if (s->for_overlaps)
2693 s->background_filled_p = true;
2694 else
2695 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, false);
2696 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2697 break;
2699 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2700 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2701 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2702 s->background_filled_p = true;
2703 else
2704 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, true);
2705 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2706 break;
2708 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2709 if (s->for_overlaps)
2710 s->background_filled_p = true;
2711 else
2712 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, true);
2713 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2714 break;
2716 default:
2717 emacs_abort ();
2720 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2722 /* Draw underline. */
2723 if (s->face->underline_p)
2725 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2727 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2728 x_draw_underwave (s);
2729 else
2731 XGCValues xgcv;
2732 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2733 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2734 x_draw_underwave (s);
2735 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2738 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2740 unsigned long thickness, position;
2741 int y;
2743 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p
2744 && s->prev->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2746 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2747 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2748 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2750 else
2752 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2753 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2754 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2755 else
2756 thickness = 1;
2757 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2758 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2759 else
2761 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2762 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2763 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2764 specs, and its default is
2766 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2767 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2769 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2770 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2771 position = s->font->underline_position;
2772 else if (s->font)
2773 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2774 else
2775 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2777 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2779 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2780 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2781 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2782 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2783 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2784 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2785 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2786 s->underline_position = position;
2787 y = s->ybase + position;
2788 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2789 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2790 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2791 else
2793 XGCValues xgcv;
2794 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2795 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2796 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2797 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2798 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2802 /* Draw overline. */
2803 if (s->face->overline_p)
2805 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2807 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2808 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2809 s->width, h);
2810 else
2812 XGCValues xgcv;
2813 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2814 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2815 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2816 s->width, h);
2817 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2821 /* Draw strike-through. */
2822 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2824 unsigned long h = 1;
2825 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2827 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2828 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2829 s->width, h);
2830 else
2832 XGCValues xgcv;
2833 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2834 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2835 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2836 s->width, h);
2837 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2841 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2842 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2843 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2845 if (s->prev)
2847 struct glyph_string *prev;
2849 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2850 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2851 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2853 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2854 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2855 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2857 prev->hl = s->hl;
2858 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2859 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2860 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2861 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2862 else
2863 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2864 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2865 prev->hl = save;
2866 prev->num_clips = 0;
2870 if (s->next)
2872 struct glyph_string *next;
2874 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2875 if (next->hl != s->hl
2876 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2878 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2879 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2880 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2882 next->hl = s->hl;
2883 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2884 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2885 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2886 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2887 else
2888 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2889 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2890 next->hl = save;
2891 next->num_clips = 0;
2892 next->clip_head = s->next;
2897 /* Reset clipping. */
2898 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2899 s->num_clips = 0;
2902 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2904 static void
2905 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2907 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2908 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2909 x, y, width, height,
2910 x + shift_by, y);
2913 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2914 for X frames. */
2916 static void
2917 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2919 emacs_abort ();
2923 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2924 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2926 void
2927 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height)
2929 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2930 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, False);
2934 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2936 static void
2937 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2939 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2940 longer visible. */
2941 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2943 block_input ();
2945 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2947 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2948 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2949 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2951 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2952 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2953 redisplay, do it here. */
2954 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2955 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2956 #endif
2958 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2960 unblock_input ();
2963 /* RIF: Show hourglass cursor on frame F. */
2965 static void
2966 x_show_hourglass (struct frame *f)
2968 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2970 if (dpy)
2972 struct x_output *x = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f);
2973 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
2974 if (x->widget)
2975 #else
2976 if (FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f))
2977 #endif
2979 x->hourglass_p = true;
2981 if (!x->hourglass_window)
2983 unsigned long mask = CWCursor;
2984 XSetWindowAttributes attrs;
2985 #ifdef USE_GTK
2986 Window parent = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2987 #else
2988 Window parent = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
2989 #endif
2990 attrs.cursor = x->hourglass_cursor;
2992 x->hourglass_window = XCreateWindow
2993 (dpy, parent, 0, 0, 32000, 32000, 0, 0,
2994 InputOnly, CopyFromParent, mask, &attrs);
2997 XMapRaised (dpy, x->hourglass_window);
2998 XFlush (dpy);
3003 /* RIF: Cancel hourglass cursor on frame F. */
3005 static void
3006 x_hide_hourglass (struct frame *f)
3008 struct x_output *x = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f);
3010 /* Watch out for newly created frames. */
3011 if (x->hourglass_window)
3013 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), x->hourglass_window);
3014 /* Sync here because XTread_socket looks at the
3015 hourglass_p flag that is reset to zero below. */
3016 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
3017 x->hourglass_p = false;
3021 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3023 static void
3024 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3026 block_input ();
3029 #ifdef USE_GTK
3030 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3031 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3032 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3033 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3034 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3035 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3036 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3037 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3038 do { \
3039 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3040 cairo_fill (cr); \
3042 while (false)
3043 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3044 GdkGCValues vals;
3045 GdkGC *gc;
3046 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3047 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3048 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3049 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3050 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3051 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3052 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3053 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3054 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3055 GC gc;
3057 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3058 pixels into background pixels. */
3060 XGCValues values;
3062 values.function = GXxor;
3063 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3064 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3066 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3067 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3069 #endif
3071 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3072 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
3073 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3074 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3075 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3076 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3077 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3078 int width = flash_right - flash_left;
3080 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3081 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3083 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3084 flash_left,
3085 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3086 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3087 width, flash_height);
3088 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3089 flash_left,
3090 (height - flash_height
3091 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3092 width, flash_height);
3095 else
3096 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3097 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3098 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3099 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3101 x_flush (f);
3104 struct timespec delay = make_timespec (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3105 struct timespec wakeup = timespec_add (current_timespec (), delay);
3107 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3108 available. */
3109 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3111 struct timespec current = current_timespec ();
3112 struct timespec timeout;
3114 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3115 if (timespec_cmp (wakeup, current) <= 0)
3116 break;
3118 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3119 timeout = make_timespec (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3121 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3122 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3126 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3127 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3129 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3130 flash_left,
3131 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3132 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3133 width, flash_height);
3134 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3135 flash_left,
3136 (height - flash_height
3137 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3138 width, flash_height);
3140 else
3141 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3142 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3143 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3144 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3146 #ifdef USE_GTK
3147 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3148 cairo_destroy (cr);
3149 #else
3150 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3151 #endif
3152 #undef XFillRectangle
3153 #else
3154 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3155 #endif
3156 x_flush (f);
3160 unblock_input ();
3164 static void
3165 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (struct frame *f, bool invisible)
3167 block_input ();
3168 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->toggle_visible_pointer (f, invisible);
3169 unblock_input ();
3173 /* Make audible bell. */
3175 static void
3176 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3178 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3180 if (visible_bell)
3181 XTflash (f);
3182 else
3184 block_input ();
3185 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
3186 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, 0, None);
3187 #else
3188 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3189 #endif
3190 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3191 unblock_input ();
3196 /***********************************************************************
3197 Line Dance
3198 ***********************************************************************/
3200 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3201 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3203 static void
3204 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3206 emacs_abort ();
3210 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3212 static void
3213 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3215 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3216 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3218 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3219 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3220 fringe of W. */
3221 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3223 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3224 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3225 bottom_y = y + height;
3227 if (to_y < from_y)
3229 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3230 line at the bottom. */
3231 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3232 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3233 else
3234 height = run->height;
3236 else
3238 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3239 at the bottom. */
3240 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3241 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3242 else
3243 height = run->height;
3246 block_input ();
3248 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3249 x_clear_cursor (w);
3251 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3252 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3253 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3254 x, from_y,
3255 width, height,
3256 x, to_y);
3258 unblock_input ();
3263 /***********************************************************************
3264 Exposure Events
3265 ***********************************************************************/
3268 static void
3269 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3271 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3272 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3273 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3274 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3275 block_input ();
3276 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3277 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3278 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3279 because of this (bug#9310). */
3280 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3281 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3282 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3283 x_uncatch_errors ();
3284 unblock_input ();
3285 x_update_cursor (f, true);
3286 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3289 static void
3290 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3292 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3293 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3294 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3295 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3296 block_input ();
3297 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3298 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3299 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3300 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3301 x_uncatch_errors ();
3302 unblock_input ();
3303 x_update_cursor (f, true);
3304 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3307 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3308 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3309 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3310 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3311 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3313 static void
3314 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3316 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3318 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3320 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3321 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3322 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3324 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3325 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3327 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3328 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3329 else
3330 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = NULL;
3333 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3336 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3337 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3338 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3340 static void
3341 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3343 if (type == FocusIn)
3345 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3347 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3348 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3350 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3351 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3352 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3353 bufp->arg = (((NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3354 || ! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (Vterminal_frame))
3355 || EQ (Fdaemonp (), Qt))
3356 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3357 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3358 ? Qt : Qnil);
3359 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3360 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3363 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3365 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3366 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3367 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3368 #endif
3370 else if (type == FocusOut)
3372 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3374 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3376 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3377 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3379 bufp->kind = FOCUS_OUT_EVENT;
3380 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3383 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3384 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3385 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3386 #endif
3387 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3388 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, false);
3392 /* Return the Emacs frame-object corresponding to an X window.
3393 It could be the frame's main window or an icon window. */
3395 static struct frame *
3396 x_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
3398 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
3399 struct frame *f;
3401 if (wdesc == None)
3402 return NULL;
3404 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3406 f = XFRAME (frame);
3407 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
3408 continue;
3409 if (f->output_data.x->hourglass_window == wdesc)
3410 return f;
3411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3412 if ((f->output_data.x->edit_widget
3413 && XtWindow (f->output_data.x->edit_widget) == wdesc)
3414 /* A tooltip frame? */
3415 || (!f->output_data.x->edit_widget
3416 && FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
3417 || f->output_data.x->icon_desc == wdesc)
3418 return f;
3419 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3420 #ifdef USE_GTK
3421 if (f->output_data.x->edit_widget)
3423 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
3424 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
3425 if (gwdesc != 0 && gwdesc == x->edit_widget)
3426 return f;
3428 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3429 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc
3430 || f->output_data.x->icon_desc == wdesc)
3431 return f;
3432 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3434 return 0;
3437 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
3439 /* Like x_window_to_frame but also compares the window with the widget's
3440 windows. */
3442 static struct frame *
3443 x_any_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
3445 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
3446 struct frame *f, *found = NULL;
3447 struct x_output *x;
3449 if (wdesc == None)
3450 return NULL;
3452 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3454 if (found)
3455 break;
3456 f = XFRAME (frame);
3457 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
3459 /* This frame matches if the window is any of its widgets. */
3460 x = f->output_data.x;
3461 if (x->hourglass_window == wdesc)
3462 found = f;
3463 else if (x->widget)
3465 #ifdef USE_GTK
3466 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
3467 if (gwdesc != 0
3468 && gtk_widget_get_toplevel (gwdesc) == x->widget)
3469 found = f;
3470 #else
3471 if (wdesc == XtWindow (x->widget)
3472 || wdesc == XtWindow (x->column_widget)
3473 || wdesc == XtWindow (x->edit_widget))
3474 found = f;
3475 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
3476 else if (lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc, x->menubar_widget))
3477 found = f;
3478 #endif
3480 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
3481 /* A tooltip frame. */
3482 found = f;
3486 return found;
3489 /* Likewise, but consider only the menu bar widget. */
3491 static struct frame *
3492 x_menubar_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo,
3493 const XEvent *event)
3495 Window wdesc = event->xany.window;
3496 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
3497 struct frame *f;
3498 struct x_output *x;
3500 if (wdesc == None)
3501 return NULL;
3503 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3505 f = XFRAME (frame);
3506 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
3507 continue;
3508 x = f->output_data.x;
3509 #ifdef USE_GTK
3510 if (x->menubar_widget && xg_event_is_for_menubar (f, event))
3511 return f;
3512 #else
3513 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
3514 if (x->menubar_widget
3515 && lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc, x->menubar_widget))
3516 return f;
3517 #endif
3519 return 0;
3522 /* Return the frame whose principal (outermost) window is WDESC.
3523 If WDESC is some other (smaller) window, we return 0. */
3525 struct frame *
3526 x_top_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
3528 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
3529 struct frame *f;
3530 struct x_output *x;
3532 if (wdesc == None)
3533 return NULL;
3535 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3537 f = XFRAME (frame);
3538 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
3539 continue;
3540 x = f->output_data.x;
3542 if (x->widget)
3544 /* This frame matches if the window is its topmost widget. */
3545 #ifdef USE_GTK
3546 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
3547 if (gwdesc == x->widget)
3548 return f;
3549 #else
3550 if (wdesc == XtWindow (x->widget))
3551 return f;
3552 #endif
3554 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
3555 /* Tooltip frame. */
3556 return f;
3558 return 0;
3561 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT && !USE_GTK */
3563 #define x_any_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
3564 #define x_top_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
3566 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
3568 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3569 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3571 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3573 static void
3574 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame,
3575 const XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3577 if (!frame)
3578 return;
3580 switch (event->type)
3582 case EnterNotify:
3583 case LeaveNotify:
3585 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3586 int focus_state
3587 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3589 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3590 && event->xcrossing.focus
3591 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3592 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3593 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3594 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3596 break;
3598 case FocusIn:
3599 case FocusOut:
3600 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3601 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3602 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3603 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3604 break;
3606 case ClientMessage:
3607 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3609 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3610 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3611 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3613 break;
3618 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3619 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3621 void
3622 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3624 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3626 #endif
3628 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3629 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3630 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3632 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3633 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3634 the appropriate X display info. */
3636 static void
3637 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3639 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3642 static void
3643 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3645 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3647 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3649 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3650 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3651 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3652 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3653 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3655 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3656 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3659 else
3660 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3662 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3664 if (old_highlight)
3665 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3666 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3667 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3673 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3675 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3676 static void
3677 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3679 int min_code, max_code;
3680 KeySym *syms;
3681 int syms_per_code;
3682 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3684 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3685 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3686 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3687 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3688 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3690 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3692 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3693 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3694 &syms_per_code);
3695 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3697 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3698 Alt keysyms are on. */
3700 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3701 bool found_alt_or_meta;
3703 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3705 found_alt_or_meta = false;
3706 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3708 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3710 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3711 if (code == 0)
3712 continue;
3714 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3716 int code_col;
3718 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3720 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3722 switch (sym)
3724 case XK_Meta_L:
3725 case XK_Meta_R:
3726 found_alt_or_meta = true;
3727 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3728 break;
3730 case XK_Alt_L:
3731 case XK_Alt_R:
3732 found_alt_or_meta = true;
3733 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3734 break;
3736 case XK_Hyper_L:
3737 case XK_Hyper_R:
3738 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3739 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3740 code_col = syms_per_code;
3741 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3742 break;
3744 case XK_Super_L:
3745 case XK_Super_R:
3746 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3747 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3748 code_col = syms_per_code;
3749 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3750 break;
3752 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3753 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3754 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3755 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3756 code_col = syms_per_code;
3757 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3758 break;
3766 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3767 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3769 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3770 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3773 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3774 make them just meta, not alt. */
3775 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3777 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3780 XFree (syms);
3781 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3784 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3785 Emacs uses. */
3788 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3790 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3791 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3792 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3793 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3794 Lisp_Object tem;
3796 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3797 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3798 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3799 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3800 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3801 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3802 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3803 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3805 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3806 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3807 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3808 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3809 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3810 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3813 static int
3814 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3816 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3817 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3818 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3819 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3821 Lisp_Object tem;
3823 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3824 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3825 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3826 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3827 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3828 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3829 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3830 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3833 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3834 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3835 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3836 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3837 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3838 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3841 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3843 char *
3844 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3846 char *value;
3848 block_input ();
3849 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3850 unblock_input ();
3852 return value;
3855 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah.
3857 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
3858 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
3859 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
3860 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
3862 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
3864 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
3865 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
3866 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
3867 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
3868 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
3869 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
3870 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
3871 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
3872 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
3873 is off. */
3875 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3877 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3878 the mouse. */
3880 static Lisp_Object
3881 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result,
3882 const XButtonEvent *event,
3883 struct frame *f)
3885 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3886 otherwise. */
3887 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3888 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3889 result->timestamp = event->time;
3890 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3891 event->state)
3892 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3893 ? up_modifier
3894 : down_modifier));
3896 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3897 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3898 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3899 result->arg = Qnil;
3900 return Qnil;
3903 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3904 The input handler calls this.
3906 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3907 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3908 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3909 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3911 static bool
3912 note_mouse_movement (struct frame *frame, const XMotionEvent *event)
3914 XRectangle *r;
3915 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3917 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3918 return false;
3920 dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame);
3921 dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3922 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_frame = frame;
3923 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_x = event->x;
3924 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_y = event->y;
3926 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3928 frame->mouse_moved = true;
3929 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
3930 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3931 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = NULL;
3932 return true;
3936 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3937 r = &dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph;
3938 if (frame != dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame
3939 || event->x < r->x || event->x >= r->x + r->width
3940 || event->y < r->y || event->y >= r->y + r->height)
3942 frame->mouse_moved = true;
3943 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
3944 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3945 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3946 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, r);
3947 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3948 return true;
3951 return false;
3954 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3955 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3957 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3958 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3959 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3960 position on the scroll bar.
3962 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3963 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3964 the mouse is over.
3966 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3967 was at this position.
3969 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3971 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3972 movement. */
3974 static void
3975 XTmouse_position (struct frame **fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3976 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3977 Time *timestamp)
3979 struct frame *f1;
3980 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
3982 block_input ();
3984 if (dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar && insist == 0)
3986 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
3988 if (bar->horizontal)
3989 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3990 else
3991 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3993 else
3995 Window root;
3996 int root_x, root_y;
3998 Window dummy_window;
3999 int dummy;
4001 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
4003 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
4004 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4005 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
4006 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
4007 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = false;
4009 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
4011 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
4012 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4013 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
4015 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
4016 &root,
4018 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
4019 a different screen. */
4020 &dummy_window,
4022 /* The position on that root window. */
4023 &root_x, &root_y,
4025 /* More trash we can't trust. */
4026 &dummy, &dummy,
4028 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
4029 we don't care. */
4030 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
4032 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
4033 containing the pointer. */
4035 Window win, child;
4036 int win_x, win_y;
4037 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
4039 win = root;
4041 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
4042 structure is changing at the same time this function
4043 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
4045 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
4047 if (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo))
4049 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
4050 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
4051 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4053 /* From-window. */
4054 root,
4056 /* To-window. */
4057 FRAME_X_WINDOW (dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame),
4059 /* From-position, to-position. */
4060 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4062 /* Child of win. */
4063 &child);
4064 f1 = dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame;
4066 else
4068 while (true)
4070 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4072 /* From-window, to-window. */
4073 root, win,
4075 /* From-position, to-position. */
4076 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4078 /* Child of win. */
4079 &child);
4081 if (child == None || child == win)
4082 break;
4083 #ifdef USE_GTK
4084 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4085 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4086 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4087 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4088 if (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win))
4089 break;
4090 #endif
4091 win = child;
4092 parent_x = win_x;
4093 parent_y = win_y;
4096 /* Now we know that:
4097 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4098 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4099 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4100 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4101 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4102 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4103 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4104 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4105 never use them in that case.) */
4107 #ifdef USE_GTK
4108 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4109 want the edit window. */
4110 f1 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win);
4111 #else
4112 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4113 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win);
4114 #endif
4116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4117 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4118 on the frame. */
4119 if (f1 != NULL
4120 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4121 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4122 f1 = NULL;
4123 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4126 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4127 f1 = 0;
4129 x_uncatch_errors ();
4131 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4132 if (! f1)
4134 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4136 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win, 2);
4138 if (bar)
4140 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4141 win_x = parent_x;
4142 win_y = parent_y;
4146 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4147 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4149 if (f1)
4151 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4152 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4153 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4154 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4155 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4156 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4157 the frame are divided into. */
4159 /* FIXME: what if F1 is not an X frame? */
4160 dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f1);
4161 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph);
4162 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4164 *bar_window = Qnil;
4165 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4166 *fp = f1;
4167 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4168 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4169 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
4174 unblock_input ();
4179 /***********************************************************************
4180 Scroll bars
4181 ***********************************************************************/
4183 /* Scroll bar support. */
4185 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4186 manages it.
4187 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4188 bits. */
4190 static struct scroll_bar *
4191 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id, int type)
4193 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4195 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4196 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4197 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4199 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4201 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4203 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4204 continue;
4206 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4207 right window ID. */
4208 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4209 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4210 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4211 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4212 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4213 condemned = Qnil,
4214 ! NILP (bar));
4215 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4216 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id
4217 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display
4218 && (type = 2
4219 || (type == 1 && XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->horizontal)
4220 || (type == 0 && !XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->horizontal)))
4221 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4224 return NULL;
4228 #if defined USE_LUCID
4230 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4231 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4233 static Widget
4234 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4236 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4238 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4239 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4241 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4243 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4244 return menu_bar;
4246 return NULL;
4249 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4252 /************************************************************************
4253 Toolkit scroll bars
4254 ************************************************************************/
4256 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4258 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, enum scroll_bar_part,
4259 int, int, bool);
4261 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4262 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4264 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4266 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4267 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4269 #ifndef USE_GTK
4270 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4272 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4273 static XtActionHookId horizontal_action_hook_id;
4275 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4277 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4278 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4279 to avoid jerkiness. */
4281 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4283 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4284 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4285 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4286 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4288 static void
4289 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4290 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4292 bool scroll_bar_p;
4293 const char *end_action;
4295 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4296 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4297 end_action = "Release";
4298 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4299 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4300 end_action = "EndScroll";
4301 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4303 if (scroll_bar_p
4304 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4305 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4307 struct window *w;
4308 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4310 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4311 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, false);
4312 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4313 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
4315 if (bar->dragging != -1)
4317 bar->dragging = -1;
4318 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4319 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4321 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4322 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
4323 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
4324 #endif
4325 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4326 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = false;
4331 static void
4332 xt_horizontal_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4333 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4335 bool scroll_bar_p;
4336 const char *end_action;
4338 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4339 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4340 end_action = "Release";
4341 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4342 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4343 end_action = "EndScroll";
4344 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4346 if (scroll_bar_p
4347 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4348 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4350 struct window *w;
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4353 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4354 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, true);
4355 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4356 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
4358 if (bar->dragging != -1)
4360 bar->dragging = -1;
4361 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4362 set_horizontal_scroll_bar (w);
4364 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4365 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
4366 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
4367 #endif
4368 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4369 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = false;
4372 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4374 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4375 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4376 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4377 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4379 static void
4380 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, enum scroll_bar_part part,
4381 int portion, int whole, bool horizontal)
4383 XEvent event;
4384 XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event.xclient;
4385 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4386 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4387 intptr_t iw = (intptr_t) w;
4388 enum { BITS_PER_INTPTR = CHAR_BIT * sizeof iw };
4389 verify (BITS_PER_INTPTR <= 64);
4390 int sign_shift = BITS_PER_INTPTR - 32;
4392 block_input ();
4394 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4395 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4396 ev->message_type = (horizontal
4397 ? FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
4398 : FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar);
4399 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4400 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4401 ev->format = 32;
4403 /* A 32-bit X client on a 64-bit X server can pass a window pointer
4404 as-is. A 64-bit client on a 32-bit X server is in trouble
4405 because a pointer does not fit and would be truncated while
4406 passing through the server. So use two slots and hope that X12
4407 will resolve such issues someday. */
4408 ev->data.l[0] = iw >> 31 >> 1;
4409 ev->data.l[1] = sign_shift <= 0 ? iw : iw << sign_shift >> sign_shift;
4410 ev->data.l[2] = part;
4411 ev->data.l[3] = portion;
4412 ev->data.l[4] = whole;
4414 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4415 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4416 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = true;
4417 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4418 #endif
4420 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4421 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4422 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4423 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4424 unblock_input ();
4428 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4429 in *IEVENT. */
4431 static void
4432 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent *event,
4433 struct input_event *ievent)
4435 const XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event->xclient;
4436 Lisp_Object window;
4437 struct window *w;
4439 /* See the comment in the function above. */
4440 intptr_t iw0 = ev->data.l[0];
4441 intptr_t iw1 = ev->data.l[1];
4442 intptr_t iw = (iw0 << 31 << 1) + (iw1 & 0xffffffffu);
4443 w = (struct window *) iw;
4445 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4447 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4448 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4449 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4450 #ifdef USE_GTK
4451 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4452 #else
4453 ievent->timestamp =
4454 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4455 #endif
4456 ievent->code = 0;
4457 ievent->part = ev->data.l[2];
4458 ievent->x = make_number (ev->data.l[3]);
4459 ievent->y = make_number (ev->data.l[4]);
4460 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4463 /* Transform a horizontal scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs
4464 input event in *IEVENT. */
4466 static void
4467 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent *event,
4468 struct input_event *ievent)
4470 const XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event->xclient;
4471 Lisp_Object window;
4472 struct window *w;
4474 /* See the comment in the function above. */
4475 intptr_t iw0 = ev->data.l[0];
4476 intptr_t iw1 = ev->data.l[1];
4477 intptr_t iw = (iw0 << 31 << 1) + (iw1 & 0xffffffffu);
4478 w = (struct window *) iw;
4480 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4482 ievent->kind = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4483 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4484 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4485 #ifdef USE_GTK
4486 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4487 #else
4488 ievent->timestamp =
4489 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4490 #endif
4491 ievent->code = 0;
4492 ievent->part = ev->data.l[2];
4493 ievent->x = make_number (ev->data.l[3]);
4494 ievent->y = make_number (ev->data.l[4]);
4495 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4499 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4501 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4503 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4505 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4506 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4507 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4509 static void
4510 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4512 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
4513 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = call_data;
4514 enum scroll_bar_part part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
4515 bool horizontal = bar->horizontal;
4516 int whole = 0, portion = 0;
4518 switch (cs->reason)
4520 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4521 bar->dragging = -1;
4522 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4523 break;
4525 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4526 bar->dragging = -1;
4527 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_right_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4528 break;
4530 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4531 bar->dragging = -1;
4532 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_above_handle;
4533 break;
4535 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4536 bar->dragging = -1;
4537 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_after_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4538 break;
4540 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4541 bar->dragging = -1;
4542 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_to_leftmost : scroll_bar_to_top;
4543 break;
4545 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4546 bar->dragging = -1;
4547 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_to_rightmost : scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4548 break;
4550 case XmCR_DRAG:
4552 int slider_size;
4554 block_input ();
4555 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4556 unblock_input ();
4558 if (horizontal)
4560 portion = bar->whole * ((float)cs->value / XM_SB_MAX);
4561 whole = bar->whole * ((float)(XM_SB_MAX - slider_size) / XM_SB_MAX);
4562 portion = min (portion, whole);
4563 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
4565 else
4567 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4568 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4569 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4572 bar->dragging = cs->value;
4574 break;
4576 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4577 break;
4580 if (part != scroll_bar_nowhere)
4582 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4583 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole,
4584 bar->horizontal);
4588 #elif defined USE_GTK
4590 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4591 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4593 static gboolean
4594 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4595 GtkScrollType scroll,
4596 gdouble value,
4597 gpointer user_data)
4599 int whole = 0, portion = 0;
4600 struct scroll_bar *bar = user_data;
4601 enum scroll_bar_part part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
4602 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4603 struct frame *f = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4605 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4607 switch (scroll)
4609 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4610 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4611 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4612 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4614 if (bar->horizontal)
4616 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
4617 whole = (int)(gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4618 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj));
4619 portion = min ((int)value, whole);
4620 bar->dragging = portion;
4622 else
4624 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4625 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4626 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4627 portion = min ((int)value, whole);
4628 bar->dragging = portion;
4631 break;
4632 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4633 part = (bar->horizontal
4634 ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_up_arrow);
4635 bar->dragging = -1;
4636 break;
4637 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4638 part = (bar->horizontal
4639 ? scroll_bar_right_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow);
4640 bar->dragging = -1;
4641 break;
4642 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4643 part = (bar->horizontal
4644 ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_above_handle);
4645 bar->dragging = -1;
4646 break;
4647 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4648 part = (bar->horizontal
4649 ? scroll_bar_after_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle);
4650 bar->dragging = -1;
4651 break;
4654 if (part != scroll_bar_nowhere)
4656 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4657 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole,
4658 bar->horizontal);
4661 return FALSE;
4664 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to -1 when dragging is done. */
4666 static gboolean
4667 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4668 GdkEventButton *event,
4669 gpointer user_data)
4671 struct scroll_bar *bar = user_data;
4672 bar->dragging = -1;
4673 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4675 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4676 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, bar->horizontal);
4677 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4680 return FALSE;
4684 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4686 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4687 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4688 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4689 the thumb is. */
4691 static void
4692 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4694 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
4695 float *top_addr = call_data;
4696 float top = *top_addr;
4697 float shown;
4698 int whole, portion, height, width;
4699 enum scroll_bar_part part;
4700 bool horizontal = bar->horizontal;
4703 if (horizontal)
4705 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4706 block_input ();
4707 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNwidth, &width, NULL);
4708 unblock_input ();
4710 if (shown < 1)
4712 whole = bar->whole - (shown * bar->whole);
4713 portion = min (top * bar->whole, whole);
4715 else
4717 whole = bar->whole;
4718 portion = 0;
4721 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
4723 else
4725 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4726 block_input ();
4727 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4728 unblock_input ();
4730 whole = 10000000;
4731 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4733 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4734 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4735 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4736 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4737 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4738 bottom). */
4739 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4740 else
4741 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4744 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4745 bar->dragging = portion;
4746 bar->last_seen_part = part;
4747 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole, bar->horizontal);
4751 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4752 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4753 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4754 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4755 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4756 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4757 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4759 static void
4760 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4762 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
4763 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4764 int position = (intptr_t) call_data;
4765 Dimension height, width;
4766 enum scroll_bar_part part;
4768 if (bar->horizontal)
4770 /* Get the width of the scroll bar. */
4771 block_input ();
4772 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNwidth, &width, NULL);
4773 unblock_input ();
4775 if (eabs (position) >= width)
4776 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_after_handle;
4778 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4779 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4780 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, width / 20))
4781 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_right_arrow;
4782 else
4783 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4785 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4786 bar->dragging = -1;
4787 bar->last_seen_part = part;
4788 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, width,
4789 bar->horizontal);
4791 else
4794 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4795 block_input ();
4796 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4797 unblock_input ();
4799 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4800 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4802 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4803 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4804 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4805 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4806 else
4807 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4809 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4810 bar->dragging = -1;
4811 bar->last_seen_part = part;
4812 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height,
4813 bar->horizontal);
4817 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4819 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4820 #define SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME "horizontalScrollBar"
4822 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4823 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4825 #ifdef USE_GTK
4826 static void
4827 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4829 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4831 block_input ();
4832 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4833 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4834 scroll_bar_name);
4835 unblock_input ();
4838 static void
4839 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4841 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME;
4843 block_input ();
4844 xg_create_horizontal_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4845 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4846 scroll_bar_name);
4847 unblock_input ();
4850 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4852 static void
4853 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4855 Window xwindow;
4856 Widget widget;
4857 Arg av[20];
4858 int ac = 0;
4859 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4860 unsigned long pixel;
4862 block_input ();
4864 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4865 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4866 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4867 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4868 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4869 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4870 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4871 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4872 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4874 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4875 if (pixel != -1)
4877 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4878 ++ac;
4881 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4882 if (pixel != -1)
4884 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4885 ++ac;
4888 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4889 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4891 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4892 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4893 (XtPointer) bar);
4894 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4895 (XtPointer) bar);
4896 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4897 (XtPointer) bar);
4898 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4899 (XtPointer) bar);
4900 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4901 (XtPointer) bar);
4902 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4903 (XtPointer) bar);
4904 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4905 (XtPointer) bar);
4907 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4908 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4910 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4911 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4912 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4913 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4915 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4917 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4918 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4919 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4920 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4921 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4922 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4923 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4924 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4926 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4927 if (pixel != -1)
4929 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4930 ++ac;
4933 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4934 if (pixel != -1)
4936 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4937 ++ac;
4940 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4942 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4943 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4945 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4946 if (pixel != -1)
4948 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4949 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4950 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4951 pixel = -1;
4952 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4955 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4957 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4958 if (pixel != -1)
4960 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4961 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4962 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4963 pixel = -1;
4964 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4968 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4969 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4970 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4971 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4972 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4973 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4974 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4975 colors itself. */
4977 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4978 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4979 ++ac;
4981 else
4982 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4983 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4984 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4986 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4987 the shadows. */
4988 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4989 ++ac;
4991 /* Specify the colors. */
4992 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4993 if (pixel != -1)
4995 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4996 ++ac;
4998 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4999 if (pixel != -1)
5001 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
5002 ++ac;
5005 #endif
5007 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
5008 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
5011 char const *initial = "";
5012 char const *val = initial;
5013 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
5014 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5015 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
5016 #endif
5017 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
5018 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
5019 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5020 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
5021 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5022 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
5026 /* Define callbacks. */
5027 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
5028 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
5029 (XtPointer) bar);
5031 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5032 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5034 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5036 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5037 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5038 if (action_hook_id == 0)
5039 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
5041 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5042 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
5043 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
5044 bar->x_window = xwindow;
5045 bar->whole = 1;
5046 bar->horizontal = false;
5048 unblock_input ();
5051 static void
5052 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
5054 Window xwindow;
5055 Widget widget;
5056 Arg av[20];
5057 int ac = 0;
5058 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME;
5059 unsigned long pixel;
5061 block_input ();
5063 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5064 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
5065 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
5066 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
5067 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
5068 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmHORIZONTAL); ++ac;
5069 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_RIGHT), ++ac;
5070 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
5071 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
5073 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
5074 if (pixel != -1)
5076 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
5077 ++ac;
5080 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5081 if (pixel != -1)
5083 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
5084 ++ac;
5087 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
5088 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
5090 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
5091 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5092 (XtPointer) bar);
5093 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5094 (XtPointer) bar);
5095 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5096 (XtPointer) bar);
5097 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5098 (XtPointer) bar);
5099 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5100 (XtPointer) bar);
5101 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5102 (XtPointer) bar);
5103 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5104 (XtPointer) bar);
5106 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5107 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5109 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
5110 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
5111 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
5112 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
5114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5116 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
5117 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
5118 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
5119 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
5120 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
5121 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientHorizontal); ++ac;
5122 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
5123 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
5125 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
5126 if (pixel != -1)
5128 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
5129 ++ac;
5132 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5133 if (pixel != -1)
5135 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
5136 ++ac;
5139 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
5141 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
5142 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
5144 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5145 if (pixel != -1)
5147 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5148 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
5149 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
5150 pixel = -1;
5151 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
5154 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
5156 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5157 if (pixel != -1)
5159 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5160 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
5161 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
5162 pixel = -1;
5163 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
5167 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
5168 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
5169 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
5170 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
5171 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
5172 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
5173 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
5174 colors itself. */
5176 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
5177 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
5178 ++ac;
5180 else
5181 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
5182 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
5183 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
5185 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
5186 the shadows. */
5187 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
5188 ++ac;
5190 /* Specify the colors. */
5191 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
5192 if (pixel != -1)
5194 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
5195 ++ac;
5197 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
5198 if (pixel != -1)
5200 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
5201 ++ac;
5204 #endif
5206 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
5207 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
5210 char const *initial = "";
5211 char const *val = initial;
5212 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
5213 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5214 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
5215 #endif
5216 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
5217 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
5218 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5219 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
5220 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5221 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
5225 /* Define callbacks. */
5226 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
5227 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
5228 (XtPointer) bar);
5230 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5231 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5233 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5235 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5236 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5237 if (horizontal_action_hook_id == 0)
5238 horizontal_action_hook_id
5239 = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_horizontal_action_hook, 0);
5241 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5242 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
5243 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
5244 bar->x_window = xwindow;
5245 bar->whole = 1;
5246 bar->horizontal = true;
5248 unblock_input ();
5250 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5253 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
5254 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
5256 #ifdef USE_GTK
5257 static void
5258 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
5260 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5263 static void
5264 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
5266 xg_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5269 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5270 static void
5271 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
5272 int whole)
5274 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5275 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5276 float top, shown;
5278 block_input ();
5280 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5282 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p)
5284 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
5285 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
5286 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
5287 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
5288 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
5289 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
5290 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
5291 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
5292 its size, the update will often happen too late.
5293 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
5294 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
5295 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
5296 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
5297 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
5298 whole += portion;
5301 if (whole <= 0)
5302 top = 0, shown = 1;
5303 else
5305 top = (float) position / whole;
5306 shown = (float) portion / whole;
5309 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5311 int size, value;
5313 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
5314 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
5315 value. */
5316 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
5318 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
5319 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
5320 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
5322 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
5324 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5326 if (whole == 0)
5327 top = 0, shown = 1;
5328 else
5330 top = (float) position / whole;
5331 shown = (float) portion / whole;
5335 float old_top, old_shown;
5336 Dimension height;
5337 XtVaGetValues (widget,
5338 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
5339 XtNshown, &old_shown,
5340 XtNheight, &height,
5341 NULL);
5343 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5344 if (bar->dragging == -1 || bar->last_seen_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
5345 top = max (0, min (1, top));
5346 else
5347 top = old_top;
5348 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5349 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
5350 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
5351 top = min (top, 0.99f);
5352 #endif
5353 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5354 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
5355 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5356 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
5357 shown = max (shown, 0.01f);
5358 #endif
5360 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
5361 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
5362 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
5363 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
5365 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5366 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5367 else
5369 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5370 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
5371 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
5373 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5377 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5379 unblock_input ();
5382 static void
5383 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
5384 int whole)
5386 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5387 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5388 float top, shown;
5390 block_input ();
5392 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5393 bar->whole = whole;
5394 shown = (float) portion / whole;
5395 top = (float) position / (whole - portion);
5397 int size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
5398 int value = clip_to_bounds (0, top * (XM_SB_MAX - size), XM_SB_MAX - size);
5400 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
5402 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5403 bar->whole = whole;
5404 if (whole == 0)
5405 top = 0, shown = 1;
5406 else
5408 top = (float) position / whole;
5409 shown = (float) portion / whole;
5413 float old_top, old_shown;
5414 Dimension height;
5415 XtVaGetValues (widget,
5416 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
5417 XtNshown, &old_shown,
5418 XtNheight, &height,
5419 NULL);
5421 #if false
5422 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5423 if (bar->dragging == -1 || bar->last_seen_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
5424 top = max (0, min (1, top));
5425 else
5426 top = old_top;
5427 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5428 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
5429 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
5430 top = min (top, 0.99f);
5431 #endif
5432 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5433 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
5434 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5435 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
5436 shown = max (shown, 0.01f);
5437 #endif
5438 #endif
5440 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
5441 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
5442 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
5443 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5444 #if false
5445 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
5447 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5448 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5449 else
5451 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5452 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
5453 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
5455 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5458 #endif
5460 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5462 unblock_input ();
5464 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5466 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5470 /************************************************************************
5471 Scroll bars, general
5472 ************************************************************************/
5474 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
5475 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
5476 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
5477 scroll bar. */
5479 static struct scroll_bar *
5480 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left,
5481 int width, int height, bool horizontal)
5483 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5484 struct scroll_bar *bar
5485 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
5486 Lisp_Object barobj;
5488 block_input ();
5490 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5491 if (horizontal)
5492 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
5493 else
5494 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
5495 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5497 XSetWindowAttributes a;
5498 unsigned long mask;
5499 Window window;
5501 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5502 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
5503 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
5505 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
5506 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
5507 | ExposureMask);
5508 a.cursor = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
5510 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
5512 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
5513 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
5514 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
5515 if (width > 0 && window_box_height (w) > 0)
5516 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5517 left, top, width, window_box_height (w));
5519 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5520 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
5521 left, top, width, height,
5522 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
5524 CopyFromParent,
5525 CopyFromParent,
5526 CopyFromParent,
5527 /* Attributes. */
5528 mask, &a);
5529 bar->x_window = window;
5531 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5533 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
5534 bar->top = top;
5535 bar->left = left;
5536 bar->width = width;
5537 bar->height = height;
5538 bar->start = 0;
5539 bar->end = 0;
5540 bar->dragging = -1;
5541 bar->horizontal = horizontal;
5542 #if defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS) && defined (USE_LUCID)
5543 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
5544 #endif
5546 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5547 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5548 bar->prev = Qnil;
5549 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5550 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5551 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5552 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5554 /* Map the window/widget. */
5555 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5557 #ifdef USE_GTK
5558 if (horizontal)
5559 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
5560 left, width, max (height, 1));
5561 else
5562 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
5563 left, width, max (height, 1));
5564 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5565 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5566 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar, left, top, width, max (height, 1), 0);
5567 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5568 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5570 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5571 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5572 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5574 unblock_input ();
5575 return bar;
5579 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5581 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5583 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5584 redrawing it, unless REBUILD; in that case, always
5585 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5586 events.)
5588 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5589 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5590 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5591 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5592 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5594 static void
5595 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end,
5596 bool rebuild)
5598 bool dragging = bar->dragging != -1;
5599 Window w = bar->x_window;
5600 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5601 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5603 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5604 if (! rebuild
5605 && start == bar->start
5606 && end == bar->end)
5607 return;
5609 block_input ();
5612 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5613 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5614 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5616 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5617 the distance between start and end. */
5619 int length = end - start;
5621 if (start < 0)
5622 start = 0;
5623 else if (start > top_range)
5624 start = top_range;
5625 end = start + length;
5627 if (end < start)
5628 end = start;
5629 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5630 end = top_range;
5633 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5634 bar->start = start;
5635 bar->end = end;
5637 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5638 if (end > top_range)
5639 end = top_range;
5641 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5642 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5643 that many pixels tall. */
5644 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5646 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5647 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5648 if ((inside_width > 0) && (start > 0))
5649 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5650 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5651 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5652 inside_width, start);
5654 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5655 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5656 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5657 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5659 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5660 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5661 /* x, y, width, height */
5662 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5663 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5664 inside_width, end - start);
5666 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5667 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5668 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5669 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5671 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5672 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5673 if ((inside_width > 0) && (end < inside_height))
5674 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5675 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5676 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5677 inside_width, inside_height - end);
5680 unblock_input ();
5683 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5685 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5686 nil. */
5688 static void
5689 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5691 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5692 block_input ();
5694 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5695 #ifdef USE_GTK
5696 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5697 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5698 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5699 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5700 #else
5701 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5702 #endif
5704 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5705 if (bar->horizontal)
5706 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5707 else
5708 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5710 unblock_input ();
5714 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5715 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5716 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5717 create one. */
5719 static void
5720 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5722 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5723 Lisp_Object barobj;
5724 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5725 int top, height, left, width;
5726 int window_y, window_height;
5728 /* Get window dimensions. */
5729 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5730 top = window_y;
5731 height = window_height;
5732 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5733 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
5735 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5736 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5738 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5740 block_input ();
5741 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5742 left, top, width, height);
5743 unblock_input ();
5746 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, max (height, 1), false);
5748 else
5750 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5751 unsigned int mask = 0;
5753 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5755 block_input ();
5757 if (left != bar->left)
5758 mask |= CWX;
5759 if (top != bar->top)
5760 mask |= CWY;
5761 if (width != bar->width)
5762 mask |= CWWidth;
5763 if (height != bar->height)
5764 mask |= CWHeight;
5766 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5768 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5769 if (mask)
5771 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5772 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5773 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5774 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5775 left, top, width, height);
5776 #ifdef USE_GTK
5777 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
5778 left, width, max (height, 1));
5779 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5780 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5781 left, top, width, max (height, 1), 0);
5782 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5784 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5786 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5787 if (mask)
5789 XWindowChanges wc;
5791 wc.x = left;
5792 wc.y = top;
5793 wc.width = width;
5794 wc.height = height;
5795 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5796 mask, &wc);
5799 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5801 /* Remember new settings. */
5802 bar->left = left;
5803 bar->top = top;
5804 bar->width = width;
5805 bar->height = height;
5807 unblock_input ();
5810 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5811 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5812 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5813 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5814 dragged. */
5815 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5817 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5819 if (whole == 0)
5820 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, false);
5821 else
5823 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5824 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5825 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, false);
5828 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5830 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5831 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5835 static void
5836 XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5838 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5839 Lisp_Object barobj;
5840 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5841 int top, height, left, width;
5842 int window_x, window_width;
5843 int pixel_width = WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w);
5845 /* Get window dimensions. */
5846 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, &window_x, 0, &window_width, 0);
5847 left = window_x;
5848 width = window_width;
5849 top = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_Y (w);
5850 height = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_HEIGHT (w);
5852 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5853 if (NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
5855 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5857 block_input ();
5859 /* Clear also part between window_width and
5860 WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH. */
5861 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5862 left, top, pixel_width, height);
5863 unblock_input ();
5866 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height, true);
5868 else
5870 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5871 unsigned int mask = 0;
5873 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
5875 block_input ();
5877 if (left != bar->left)
5878 mask |= CWX;
5879 if (top != bar->top)
5880 mask |= CWY;
5881 if (width != bar->width)
5882 mask |= CWWidth;
5883 if (height != bar->height)
5884 mask |= CWHeight;
5886 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5887 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5888 if (mask)
5890 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5891 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5892 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5893 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5894 WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w), top,
5895 pixel_width - WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w), height);
5896 #ifdef USE_GTK
5897 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top, left,
5898 width, height);
5899 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5900 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5901 left, top, width, height, 0);
5902 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5904 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5906 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5907 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5908 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5909 example. */
5911 int area_height = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_HEIGHT (w);
5912 int rest = area_height - height;
5913 if (rest > 0 && width > 0)
5914 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5915 left, top, width, rest);
5918 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5919 if (mask)
5921 XWindowChanges wc;
5923 wc.x = left;
5924 wc.y = top;
5925 wc.width = width;
5926 wc.height = height;
5927 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5928 mask, &wc);
5931 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5933 /* Remember new settings. */
5934 bar->left = left;
5935 bar->top = top;
5936 bar->width = width;
5937 bar->height = height;
5939 unblock_input ();
5942 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5943 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5944 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5945 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5946 dragged. */
5947 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5949 int left_range = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, width);
5951 if (whole == 0)
5952 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, left_range, false);
5953 else
5955 int start = ((double) position * left_range) / whole;
5956 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * left_range) / whole;
5957 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, false);
5960 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5962 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5963 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5967 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5968 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5969 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5970 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5971 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5972 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5973 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5975 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5976 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5977 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5979 static void
5980 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (struct frame *frame)
5982 if (!NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5984 if (!NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5986 /* Prepend scrollbars to already condemned ones. */
5987 Lisp_Object last = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5989 while (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next))
5990 last = XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next;
5992 XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5993 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = last;
5996 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame));
5997 fset_scroll_bars (frame, Qnil);
6002 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
6003 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
6005 static void
6006 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
6008 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6009 Lisp_Object barobj;
6010 struct frame *f;
6012 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
6013 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar) && NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6014 emacs_abort ();
6016 if (!NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar) && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
6018 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
6019 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6020 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
6021 if (NILP (bar->prev))
6023 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6024 the lists. */
6025 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), w->vertical_scroll_bar))
6026 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6027 goto horizontal;
6028 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
6029 w->vertical_scroll_bar))
6030 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
6031 else
6032 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6033 one or the other! */
6034 emacs_abort ();
6036 else
6037 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
6039 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6040 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
6042 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6043 bar->prev = Qnil;
6044 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6045 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
6046 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6047 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
6050 horizontal:
6051 if (!NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar) && WINDOW_HAS_HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
6053 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
6054 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6055 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
6056 if (NILP (bar->prev))
6058 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6059 the lists. */
6060 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6061 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6062 return;
6063 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
6064 w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6065 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
6066 else
6067 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6068 one or the other! */
6069 emacs_abort ();
6071 else
6072 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
6074 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6075 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
6077 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6078 bar->prev = Qnil;
6079 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6080 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
6081 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6082 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
6086 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
6087 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
6089 static void
6090 XTjudge_scroll_bars (struct frame *f)
6092 Lisp_Object bar, next;
6094 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6096 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
6097 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
6098 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
6100 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
6102 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
6104 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
6106 next = b->next;
6107 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
6110 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
6111 and they should get garbage-collected. */
6115 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6116 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
6117 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
6119 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6120 mark bits. */
6122 static void
6123 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, const XEvent *event)
6125 Window w = bar->x_window;
6126 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6127 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
6129 block_input ();
6131 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, true);
6133 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
6134 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
6135 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
6136 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
6138 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
6139 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
6140 /* x, y, width, height */
6141 0, 0, bar->width - 1, bar->height - 1);
6143 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
6144 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
6145 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
6146 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
6148 unblock_input ();
6151 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6153 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
6154 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
6156 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6157 mark bits. */
6160 static void
6161 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar,
6162 const XEvent *event,
6163 struct input_event *emacs_event)
6165 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
6166 emacs_abort ();
6168 emacs_event->kind = (bar->horizontal
6169 ? HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
6170 : SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT);
6171 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
6172 emacs_event->modifiers
6173 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO
6174 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
6175 event->xbutton.state)
6176 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
6177 ? up_modifier
6178 : down_modifier));
6179 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
6180 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
6181 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
6182 if (bar->horizontal)
6184 int left_range
6185 = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, bar->width);
6186 int x = event->xbutton.x - HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER;
6188 if (x < 0) x = 0;
6189 if (x > left_range) x = left_range;
6191 if (x < bar->start)
6192 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_before_handle;
6193 else if (x < bar->end + HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
6194 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
6195 else
6196 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_after_handle;
6198 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6199 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
6200 if (event->type == ButtonRelease && bar->dragging != -1)
6202 int new_start = - bar->dragging;
6203 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
6205 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, false);
6206 bar->dragging = -1;
6208 #endif
6210 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, left_range);
6211 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, x);
6213 else
6215 int top_range
6216 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
6217 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
6219 if (y < 0) y = 0;
6220 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
6222 if (y < bar->start)
6223 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
6224 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
6225 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
6226 else
6227 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
6229 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6230 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
6231 if (event->type == ButtonRelease && bar->dragging != -1)
6233 int new_start = y - bar->dragging;
6234 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
6236 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, false);
6237 bar->dragging = -1;
6239 #endif
6241 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
6242 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
6246 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6248 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
6250 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6251 mark bits. */
6253 static void
6254 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar,
6255 const XMotionEvent *event)
6257 struct frame *f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
6258 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6260 dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
6261 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = bar;
6262 f->mouse_moved = true;
6264 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
6265 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6267 /* Where should the handle be now? */
6268 int new_start = event->y - bar->dragging;
6270 if (new_start != bar->start)
6272 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
6274 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, false);
6279 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6281 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
6282 on the scroll bar. */
6284 static void
6285 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
6286 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
6287 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
6289 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
6290 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
6291 Window w = bar->x_window;
6292 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6293 int win_x, win_y;
6294 Window dummy_window;
6295 int dummy_coord;
6296 unsigned int dummy_mask;
6298 block_input ();
6300 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
6301 report that. */
6302 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
6304 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
6305 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
6306 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
6308 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
6309 &win_x, &win_y,
6311 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
6312 &dummy_mask))
6314 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
6316 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
6318 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6319 win_y -= bar->dragging;
6321 if (win_y < 0)
6322 win_y = 0;
6323 if (win_y > top_range)
6324 win_y = top_range;
6326 *fp = f;
6327 *bar_window = bar->window;
6329 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6330 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
6331 else if (win_y < bar->start)
6332 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
6333 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
6334 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
6335 else
6336 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
6338 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
6339 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
6341 f->mouse_moved = false;
6342 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
6343 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
6346 unblock_input ();
6350 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
6351 on the scroll bar. */
6353 static void
6354 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
6355 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
6356 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
6358 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
6359 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
6360 Window w = bar->x_window;
6361 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6362 int win_x, win_y;
6363 Window dummy_window;
6364 int dummy_coord;
6365 unsigned int dummy_mask;
6367 block_input ();
6369 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
6370 report that. */
6371 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
6373 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
6374 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
6375 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
6377 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
6378 &win_x, &win_y,
6380 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
6381 &dummy_mask))
6383 int left_range = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, bar->width);
6385 win_x -= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER;
6387 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6388 win_x -= bar->dragging;
6390 if (win_x < 0)
6391 win_x = 0;
6392 if (win_x > left_range)
6393 win_x = left_range;
6395 *fp = f;
6396 *bar_window = bar->window;
6398 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6399 *part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
6400 else if (win_x < bar->start)
6401 *part = scroll_bar_before_handle;
6402 else if (win_x < bar->end + HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
6403 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
6404 else
6405 *part = scroll_bar_after_handle;
6407 XSETINT (*y, win_x);
6408 XSETINT (*x, left_range);
6410 f->mouse_moved = false;
6411 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
6412 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
6415 unblock_input ();
6419 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
6420 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
6421 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
6422 redraw them. */
6424 static void
6425 x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *f)
6427 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6428 Lisp_Object bar;
6430 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
6431 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
6432 But in that case we should not clear them. */
6433 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
6434 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
6435 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
6436 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6437 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
6438 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
6439 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6442 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
6444 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
6445 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
6447 static int temp_index;
6448 static short temp_buffer[100];
6450 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
6451 if (temp_index == ARRAYELTS (temp_buffer)) \
6452 temp_index = 0; \
6453 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
6455 #else /* not ENABLE_CHECKING */
6457 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) ((void)0)
6459 #endif /* ENABLE_CHECKING */
6461 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
6462 on a particular display. */
6464 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
6466 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
6467 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
6468 We try all the open displays, one by one.
6469 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
6471 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
6473 enum
6475 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
6476 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
6477 X_EVENT_DROP
6480 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
6481 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
6482 EVENT is the X event to filter.
6484 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
6485 this event further.
6486 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
6488 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6489 static int
6490 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
6492 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
6493 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
6494 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
6495 was created. */
6497 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6498 event->xclient.window);
6500 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
6502 #endif
6504 #ifdef USE_GTK
6505 static int current_count;
6506 static int current_finish;
6507 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
6509 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
6510 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
6511 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
6512 static GdkFilterReturn
6513 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
6515 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
6517 block_input ();
6518 if (current_count >= 0)
6520 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6522 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
6524 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6525 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
6526 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
6527 so we do it here. */
6528 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
6529 && dpyinfo
6530 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
6532 unblock_input ();
6533 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
6535 #endif
6537 if (! dpyinfo)
6538 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6539 else
6540 current_count
6541 += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
6542 current_hold_quit);
6544 else
6545 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
6547 unblock_input ();
6549 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
6550 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
6552 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
6554 #endif /* USE_GTK */
6557 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
6558 enum xembed_message,
6559 long detail, long data1, long data2);
6561 static void
6562 x_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, Window window)
6564 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
6565 Lisp_Object lval = Qnil;
6566 bool sticky = false;
6568 get_current_wm_state (f, window, &value, &sticky);
6570 switch (value)
6572 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
6573 lval = Qfullwidth;
6574 break;
6575 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
6576 lval = Qfullheight;
6577 break;
6578 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
6579 lval = Qfullboth;
6580 break;
6581 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
6582 lval = Qmaximized;
6583 break;
6586 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
6587 /** store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil); **/
6590 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
6592 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
6593 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
6594 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
6595 *EVENT is unchanged unless we're processing KeyPress event.
6597 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
6599 static int
6600 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo,
6601 const XEvent *event,
6602 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
6604 union {
6605 struct input_event ie;
6606 struct selection_input_event sie;
6607 } inev;
6608 int count = 0;
6609 int do_help = 0;
6610 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
6611 struct frame *any, *f = NULL;
6612 struct coding_system coding;
6613 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
6614 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
6615 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
6616 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
6617 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay. */
6618 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
6620 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
6622 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6624 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
6625 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
6626 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
6628 any = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
6630 if (any && any->wait_event_type == event->type)
6631 any->wait_event_type = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
6633 switch (event->type)
6635 case ClientMessage:
6637 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
6638 && event->xclient.format == 32)
6640 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
6642 /* Use the value returned by x_any_window_to_frame
6643 because this could be the shell widget window
6644 if the frame has no title bar. */
6645 f = any;
6646 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6647 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
6648 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
6649 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
6650 #endif
6651 #if false
6652 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
6653 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
6654 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
6655 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
6656 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
6657 needed.
6659 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
6660 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
6661 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
6662 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
6663 Emacs. */
6665 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
6666 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
6667 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
6668 if (f)
6670 Display *d = event->xclient.display;
6671 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
6672 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
6673 x_catch_errors (d);
6674 XSetInputFocus (d, event->xclient.window,
6675 /* The ICCCM says this is
6676 the only valid choice. */
6677 RevertToParent,
6678 event->xclient.data.l[1]);
6679 /* This is needed to detect the error
6680 if there is an error. */
6681 XSync (d, False);
6682 x_uncatch_errors ();
6684 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
6685 #endif
6686 goto done;
6689 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
6691 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
6692 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
6693 the session manager, who's looking for such a
6694 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
6695 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
6696 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
6697 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
6698 session manager and one for this. */
6699 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6700 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
6701 #endif
6703 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6704 event->xclient.window);
6705 /* This is just so we only give real data once
6706 for a single Emacs process. */
6707 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
6708 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6709 event->xclient.window,
6710 initial_argv, initial_argc);
6711 else if (f)
6712 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6713 event->xclient.window,
6714 0, 0);
6716 goto done;
6719 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
6721 f = any;
6722 if (!f)
6723 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6725 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
6726 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6727 goto done;
6730 goto done;
6733 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6734 goto done;
6736 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6738 int new_x, new_y;
6739 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xclient.window);
6741 new_x = event->xclient.data.s[0];
6742 new_y = event->xclient.data.s[1];
6744 if (f)
6746 f->left_pos = new_x;
6747 f->top_pos = new_y;
6749 goto done;
6752 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6753 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6755 f = any;
6756 if (f)
6757 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget,
6758 NULL, (XEvent *) event, NULL);
6759 goto done;
6761 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6763 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE
6764 || event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE)
6766 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6767 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6768 currently never do because we are interested in
6769 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6770 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event->xclient.data.l[1];
6771 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xclient.window);
6772 if (!f)
6773 goto OTHER;
6774 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6775 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6776 goto done;
6779 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6780 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6781 we construct an input_event. */
6782 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6784 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, &inev.ie);
6785 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6786 goto done;
6788 else if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar)
6790 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, &inev.ie);
6791 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6792 goto done;
6794 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6796 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6797 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6799 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
6800 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6801 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
6803 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6804 goto done;
6807 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
6809 f = any;
6810 if (!f)
6811 goto OTHER;
6812 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event->xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6813 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6815 break;
6817 case SelectionNotify:
6818 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xselection.time);
6819 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6820 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselection.requestor))
6821 goto OTHER;
6822 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6823 x_handle_selection_notify (&event->xselection);
6824 break;
6826 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6827 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xselectionclear.time);
6828 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6829 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselectionclear.window))
6830 goto OTHER;
6831 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6833 const XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &event->xselectionclear;
6835 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6836 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev.sie) = dpyinfo;
6837 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6838 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6840 break;
6842 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6843 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xselectionrequest.time);
6844 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6845 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselectionrequest.owner))
6846 goto OTHER;
6847 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6849 const XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &event->xselectionrequest;
6851 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6852 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev.sie) = dpyinfo;
6853 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6854 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6855 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6856 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6857 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6859 break;
6861 case PropertyNotify:
6862 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xproperty.time);
6863 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xproperty.window);
6864 if (f && event->xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6866 bool not_hidden = x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event->xproperty);
6867 if (not_hidden && FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6869 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6870 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6871 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6872 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6873 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, false);
6874 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = true;
6875 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6876 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6878 else if (! not_hidden && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6880 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
6881 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
6882 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6883 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6887 x_handle_property_notify (&event->xproperty);
6888 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
6889 goto OTHER;
6891 case ReparentNotify:
6892 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xreparent.window);
6893 if (f)
6895 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event->xreparent.parent;
6896 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6898 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6899 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6900 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6902 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6904 goto OTHER;
6906 case Expose:
6907 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xexpose.window);
6908 if (f)
6910 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
6912 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6913 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, false);
6914 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = true;
6915 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6917 else
6919 #ifdef USE_GTK
6920 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6 and later, see
6921 http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=15398. */
6922 x_clear_area (event->xexpose.display,
6923 event->xexpose.window,
6924 event->xexpose.x, event->xexpose.y,
6925 event->xexpose.width, event->xexpose.height);
6926 #endif
6927 expose_frame (f, event->xexpose.x, event->xexpose.y,
6928 event->xexpose.width, event->xexpose.height);
6931 else
6933 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6934 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6935 #endif
6936 #if defined USE_LUCID
6937 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6938 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6939 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6941 Widget widget = x_window_to_menu_bar (event->xexpose.window);
6942 if (widget)
6943 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6945 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6947 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6948 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6949 goto OTHER;
6950 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6951 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xexpose.display,
6952 event->xexpose.window, 2);
6954 if (bar)
6955 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event);
6956 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6957 else
6958 goto OTHER;
6959 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6960 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6962 break;
6964 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6965 source area was obscured or not
6966 available. */
6967 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6968 if (f)
6969 expose_frame (f, event->xgraphicsexpose.x,
6970 event->xgraphicsexpose.y,
6971 event->xgraphicsexpose.width,
6972 event->xgraphicsexpose.height);
6973 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6974 else
6975 goto OTHER;
6976 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6977 break;
6979 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6980 source area was completely
6981 available. */
6982 break;
6984 case UnmapNotify:
6985 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6986 if (event->xunmap.window == tip_window)
6988 tip_window = 0;
6989 x_redo_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo);
6992 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xunmap.window);
6993 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6994 the frame was deleted. */
6996 bool visible = FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);
6997 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6998 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6999 display that won't ever be seen. */
7000 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
7001 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
7002 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
7003 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
7004 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
7005 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
7006 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
7007 if (visible || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
7009 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
7010 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
7011 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7014 goto OTHER;
7016 case MapNotify:
7017 if (event->xmap.window == tip_window)
7018 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
7019 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
7020 goto OTHER;
7022 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
7023 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
7024 frame is visible. */
7025 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xmap.window);
7026 if (f)
7028 bool iconified = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
7030 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
7031 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
7032 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
7033 x_check_fullscreen (f);
7035 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
7036 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, false);
7037 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = true;
7039 if (iconified)
7041 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
7042 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7044 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
7045 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
7046 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
7047 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
7049 #ifdef USE_GTK
7050 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
7051 #endif
7053 goto OTHER;
7055 case KeyPress:
7057 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xkey.time);
7058 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7060 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7061 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
7062 if (popup_activated ())
7063 goto OTHER;
7064 #endif
7066 f = any;
7068 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7069 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
7070 mouse highlighting. */
7071 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
7072 && (f == 0
7073 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
7075 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7076 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = true;
7078 #endif
7080 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7081 if (f == 0)
7083 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
7084 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
7085 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
7086 event->xkey.window);
7087 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
7089 widget = XtParent (widget);
7090 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
7093 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7095 if (f != 0)
7097 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
7098 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
7099 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
7100 his Emacs hang.
7102 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
7103 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
7104 status_return even if the input is too long to
7105 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
7106 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
7107 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
7108 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
7109 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
7110 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
7111 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
7112 int modifiers;
7113 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
7114 Lisp_Object c;
7115 /* Event will be modified. */
7116 XKeyEvent xkey = event->xkey;
7118 #ifdef USE_GTK
7119 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
7120 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
7121 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is nonzero
7122 (see above). */
7123 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7124 #endif
7126 xkey.state |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
7127 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
7128 modifiers = xkey.state;
7130 /* This will have to go some day... */
7132 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
7133 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
7134 xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
7135 xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
7136 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
7137 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
7138 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
7140 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
7141 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
7142 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
7143 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
7144 not it is combined with Meta. */
7145 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
7146 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
7148 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7149 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
7151 Status status_return;
7153 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
7154 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
7155 &xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
7156 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
7157 &status_return);
7158 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
7160 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
7161 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
7162 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
7163 &xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
7164 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
7165 &status_return);
7167 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
7168 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
7169 break;
7170 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
7172 keysym = NoSymbol;
7173 modifiers = 0;
7175 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
7176 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
7177 emacs_abort ();
7179 else
7180 nbytes = XLookupString (&xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
7181 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
7182 &compose_status);
7183 #else
7184 nbytes = XLookupString (&xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
7185 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
7186 &compose_status);
7187 #endif
7189 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
7190 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
7191 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
7192 break;
7194 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
7195 orig_keysym = keysym;
7197 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
7198 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7199 inev.ie.modifiers
7200 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
7201 inev.ie.timestamp = xkey.time;
7203 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
7204 translations to characters. */
7205 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
7206 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
7208 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
7209 inev.ie.code = keysym;
7210 goto done_keysym;
7213 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
7214 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
7216 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
7217 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
7218 else
7219 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
7220 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
7221 goto done_keysym;
7224 /* Now non-ASCII. */
7225 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
7226 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
7227 Vx_keysym_table,
7228 Qnil),
7229 NATNUMP (c)))
7231 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
7232 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
7233 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
7234 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
7235 goto done_keysym;
7238 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
7239 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
7240 || keysym == XK_Delete
7241 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
7242 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
7243 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
7244 #endif
7245 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
7246 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
7247 #ifdef HPUX
7248 /* This recognizes the "extended function
7249 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
7250 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
7251 mode_switch incorrectly. */
7252 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
7253 #endif
7254 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
7255 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
7256 #endif
7257 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
7258 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
7259 #endif
7260 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
7261 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
7262 #endif
7263 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
7264 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
7265 #endif
7266 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
7267 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
7268 #endif
7269 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
7270 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
7271 #endif
7272 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
7273 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
7274 #endif
7275 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
7276 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
7277 #endif
7278 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
7279 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
7280 #endif
7281 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
7282 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
7283 #endif
7284 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
7285 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
7286 #endif
7287 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
7288 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
7289 #endif
7290 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
7291 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
7292 #endif
7293 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
7294 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
7295 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
7296 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
7297 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
7298 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
7299 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
7300 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
7301 don't have real modifiers but
7302 should be treated similarly to
7303 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
7304 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
7305 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
7306 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
7307 #endif
7310 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
7311 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
7312 key. */
7313 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
7314 inev.ie.code = keysym;
7315 goto done_keysym;
7318 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
7319 ptrdiff_t i;
7320 int nchars, len;
7322 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
7324 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
7325 nchars++;
7326 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
7329 if (nchars < nbytes)
7331 /* Decode the input data. */
7333 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
7334 which depends on which X*LookupString function
7335 we used just above and the locale. */
7336 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
7337 coding.src_multibyte = false;
7338 coding.dst_multibyte = true;
7339 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
7340 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
7341 gives us composition information. */
7342 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
7344 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
7345 nbytes);
7346 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
7347 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
7348 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
7349 nbytes = coding.produced;
7350 nchars = coding.produced_char;
7351 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
7354 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
7355 character events. */
7356 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
7358 int ch;
7359 if (nchars == nbytes)
7360 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
7361 else
7362 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
7363 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
7364 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
7365 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
7366 inev.ie.code = ch;
7367 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7370 count += nchars;
7372 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
7374 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
7375 break;
7377 /* FIXME: check side effects and remove this. */
7378 ((XEvent *) event)->xkey = xkey;
7380 done_keysym:
7381 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7382 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
7383 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
7384 client. */
7385 break;
7386 #else
7387 goto OTHER;
7388 #endif
7390 case KeyRelease:
7391 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xkey.time);
7392 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7393 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
7394 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
7395 client. */
7396 break;
7397 #else
7398 goto OTHER;
7399 #endif
7401 case EnterNotify:
7402 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xcrossing.time);
7403 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7405 f = any;
7407 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
7408 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event->xmotion.time + 200;
7410 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
7411 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
7412 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
7413 note_mouse_movement (f, &event->xmotion);
7414 #ifdef USE_GTK
7415 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
7416 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
7417 if (!f && dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame)
7418 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event->xmotion);
7419 #endif
7420 goto OTHER;
7422 case FocusIn:
7423 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7424 goto OTHER;
7426 case LeaveNotify:
7427 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xcrossing.time);
7428 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7430 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xcrossing.window);
7431 if (f)
7433 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
7435 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
7436 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
7437 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7438 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
7441 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
7442 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
7443 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
7444 the mouse leaves the frame. */
7445 if (any_help_event_p)
7446 do_help = -1;
7448 #ifdef USE_GTK
7449 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
7450 else if (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame)
7451 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event->xmotion);
7452 #endif
7453 goto OTHER;
7455 case FocusOut:
7456 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7457 goto OTHER;
7459 case MotionNotify:
7461 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xmotion.time);
7462 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
7463 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7465 f = (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo) ? dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame
7466 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xmotion.window));
7468 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
7470 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = false;
7471 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7474 #ifdef USE_GTK
7475 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, event))
7476 f = 0;
7477 #endif
7478 if (f)
7481 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
7482 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
7483 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
7485 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_window;
7486 Lisp_Object window = window_from_coordinates
7487 (f, event->xmotion.x, event->xmotion.y, 0, false);
7489 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
7490 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
7491 will be selected only when it is active. */
7492 if (WINDOWP (window)
7493 && !EQ (window, last_mouse_window)
7494 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
7495 /* For click-to-focus window managers
7496 create event iff we don't leave the
7497 selected frame. */
7498 && (focus_follows_mouse
7499 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
7500 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
7502 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
7503 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
7505 /* Remember the last window where we saw the mouse. */
7506 last_mouse_window = window;
7508 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event->xmotion))
7509 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
7511 else
7513 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7514 struct scroll_bar *bar
7515 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xmotion.display,
7516 event->xmotion.window, 2);
7518 if (bar)
7519 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event->xmotion);
7520 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7522 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
7523 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
7524 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7527 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
7528 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
7529 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
7530 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
7531 do_help = 1;
7532 goto OTHER;
7535 case ConfigureNotify:
7536 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xconfigure.window);
7537 #ifdef USE_GTK
7538 if (!f
7539 && (f = any)
7540 && event->xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
7542 xg_frame_resized (f, event->xconfigure.width,
7543 event->xconfigure.height);
7544 f = 0;
7546 #endif
7547 if (f)
7549 x_net_wm_state (f, event->xconfigure.window);
7551 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7552 #ifndef USE_GTK
7553 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f, event->xconfigure.width);
7554 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f, event->xconfigure.height);
7556 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
7557 is called by the code that handles resizing
7558 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
7560 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
7561 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
7562 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
7563 if (width != FRAME_TEXT_WIDTH (f)
7564 || height != FRAME_TEXT_HEIGHT (f)
7565 || event->xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7566 || event->xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
7568 change_frame_size (f, width, height, false, true, false, true);
7569 x_clear_under_internal_border (f);
7570 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
7571 cancel_mouse_face (f);
7573 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7574 #endif
7576 #ifdef USE_GTK
7577 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
7578 Only get real positions when mapped. */
7579 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
7580 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
7581 #endif
7582 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
7584 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7585 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
7586 xic_set_statusarea (f);
7587 #endif
7590 goto OTHER;
7592 case ButtonRelease:
7593 case ButtonPress:
7595 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
7596 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
7597 bool tool_bar_p = false;
7599 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
7600 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = NULL;
7601 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xbutton.time);
7603 f = (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo) ? dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame
7604 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xbutton.window));
7606 #ifdef USE_GTK
7607 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, event))
7608 f = 0;
7609 #endif
7610 if (f)
7612 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7613 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
7614 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
7615 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
7617 Lisp_Object window;
7618 int x = event->xbutton.x;
7619 int y = event->xbutton.y;
7621 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, true);
7622 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
7624 if (tool_bar_p && event->xbutton.button < 4)
7625 handle_tool_bar_click
7626 (f, x, y, event->xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
7627 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, event->xbutton.state));
7629 #endif /* !USE_GTK */
7631 if (!tool_bar_p)
7632 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7633 if (! popup_activated ())
7634 #endif
7636 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
7638 if (event->type == ButtonPress
7639 && event->xbutton.time > ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
7641 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7642 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event->xbutton, f);
7644 if (event->type == ButtonRelease)
7645 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7647 else
7648 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event->xbutton, f);
7650 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
7651 xembed_send_message (f, event->xbutton.time,
7652 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
7654 else
7656 struct scroll_bar *bar
7657 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xbutton.display,
7658 event->xbutton.window, 2);
7660 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7661 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
7662 scroll bars. */
7663 if (bar && event->xbutton.state & ControlMask)
7665 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, &inev.ie);
7666 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7668 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7669 if (bar)
7670 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, &inev.ie);
7671 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7674 if (event->type == ButtonPress)
7676 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event->xbutton.button);
7677 dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame = f;
7678 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7679 if (f && !tool_bar_p)
7680 f->last_tool_bar_item = -1;
7681 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7683 else
7684 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event->xbutton.button);
7686 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
7687 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
7688 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
7689 if (f != 0)
7690 f->mouse_moved = false;
7692 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7693 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event);
7694 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
7695 don't pass it to Xt right now.
7696 Instead, save it away
7697 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
7698 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
7699 if (! popup_activated ()
7700 #ifdef USE_GTK
7701 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
7702 && event->xbutton.button < 3
7703 #endif
7704 && f && event->type == ButtonPress
7705 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7706 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7707 && event->xbutton.x >= 0
7708 && event->xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7709 && event->xbutton.y >= 0
7710 && event->xbutton.y < FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f)
7711 && event->xbutton.same_screen)
7713 if (!f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
7714 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = xmalloc (sizeof *event);
7715 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = *event;
7716 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT;
7717 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7718 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7720 else
7721 goto OTHER;
7722 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7724 break;
7726 case CirculateNotify:
7727 goto OTHER;
7729 case CirculateRequest:
7730 goto OTHER;
7732 case VisibilityNotify:
7733 goto OTHER;
7735 case MappingNotify:
7736 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7737 local cache. */
7738 switch (event->xmapping.request)
7740 case MappingModifier:
7741 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7742 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7743 case MappingKeyboard:
7744 XRefreshKeyboardMapping ((XMappingEvent *) &event->xmapping);
7746 goto OTHER;
7748 case DestroyNotify:
7749 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
7750 break;
7752 default:
7753 OTHER:
7754 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7755 block_input ();
7756 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7757 XtDispatchEvent ((XEvent *) event);
7758 unblock_input ();
7759 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7760 break;
7763 done:
7764 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7766 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7767 count++;
7770 if (do_help
7771 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7773 Lisp_Object frame;
7775 if (f)
7776 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7777 else
7778 frame = Qnil;
7780 if (do_help > 0)
7782 any_help_event_p = true;
7783 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7784 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7786 else
7788 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7789 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7791 count++;
7794 SAFE_FREE ();
7795 return count;
7798 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7799 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7800 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7802 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7804 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7806 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7807 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7809 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7811 if (dpyinfo)
7812 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7814 return finish;
7817 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7818 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7820 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7821 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7822 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7823 C chars). */
7825 static int
7826 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7828 int count = 0;
7829 bool event_found = false;
7830 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
7832 block_input ();
7834 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7835 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7837 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7838 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7841 #ifndef USE_GTK
7842 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7844 int finish;
7845 XEvent event;
7847 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7849 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7850 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7851 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7852 continue;
7853 #endif
7854 event_found = true;
7856 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7858 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7859 break;
7862 #else /* USE_GTK */
7864 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7865 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7866 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7867 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7869 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7870 from all displays. */
7872 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7874 current_count = count;
7875 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7877 gtk_main_iteration ();
7879 count = current_count;
7880 current_count = -1;
7881 current_hold_quit = 0;
7883 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7884 break;
7886 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7888 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7889 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7890 if (! event_found)
7892 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7893 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7894 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7895 x_noop_count++;
7896 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7898 x_noop_count=0;
7900 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7901 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7903 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7905 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7906 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7910 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7911 raise it now. FIXME: handle more than one such frame. */
7912 if (dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame)
7914 x_raise_frame (dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame);
7915 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = NULL;
7918 unblock_input ();
7920 return count;
7926 /***********************************************************************
7927 Text Cursor
7928 ***********************************************************************/
7930 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7931 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7933 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7934 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7935 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7937 static void
7938 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
7939 enum glyph_row_area area, GC gc)
7941 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7942 XRectangle clip_rect;
7943 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7945 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7947 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7948 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7949 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7950 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7951 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7953 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7957 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7959 static void
7960 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7962 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7963 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7964 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7965 int x, y, wd, h;
7966 XGCValues xgcv;
7967 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7968 GC gc;
7970 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7971 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7972 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7973 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7974 return;
7976 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7977 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7978 wd = w->phys_cursor_width - 1;
7980 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7981 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7982 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7983 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7984 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7985 else
7986 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7987 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7988 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7990 /* When on R2L character, show cursor at the right edge of the
7991 glyph, unless the cursor box is as wide as the glyph or wider
7992 (the latter happens when x-stretch-cursor is non-nil). */
7993 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0
7994 && cursor_glyph->pixel_width > wd)
7996 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - wd;
7997 if (wd > 0)
7998 wd -= 1;
8000 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
8001 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
8002 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
8003 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
8007 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
8009 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
8010 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
8011 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
8012 --gerd. */
8014 static void
8015 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
8017 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8018 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
8020 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
8021 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
8022 and mini-buffer. */
8023 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
8024 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
8025 return;
8027 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
8028 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
8029 the bar might not be in the window. */
8030 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
8032 struct glyph_row *r;
8033 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
8034 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
8036 else
8038 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8039 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8040 GC gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
8041 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
8042 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
8043 XGCValues xgcv;
8045 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
8046 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
8047 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
8048 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
8049 that the glyph is legible. */
8050 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
8051 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
8052 else
8053 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
8054 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
8056 if (gc)
8057 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
8058 else
8060 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
8061 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
8064 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
8066 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
8068 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
8070 if (width < 0)
8071 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
8072 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
8074 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
8076 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
8077 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
8078 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
8079 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
8081 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
8082 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
8083 width, row->height);
8085 else /* HBAR_CURSOR */
8087 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
8088 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
8090 if (width < 0)
8091 width = row->height;
8093 width = min (row->height, width);
8095 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
8096 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
8098 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0
8099 && cursor_glyph->pixel_width > w->phys_cursor_width - 1)
8100 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - w->phys_cursor_width + 1;
8101 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
8102 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
8103 row->height - width),
8104 w->phys_cursor_width - 1, width);
8107 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
8112 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
8114 static void
8115 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
8117 if (!f->pointer_invisible
8118 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
8119 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
8120 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
8124 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
8126 static void
8127 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
8129 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), x, y, width, height);
8130 #ifdef USE_GTK
8131 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
8132 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8133 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
8134 #endif
8138 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
8140 static void
8141 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x,
8142 int y, enum text_cursor_kinds cursor_type,
8143 int cursor_width, bool on_p, bool active_p)
8145 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
8147 if (on_p)
8149 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
8150 w->phys_cursor_on_p = true;
8152 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
8153 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
8154 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
8155 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
8157 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = true;
8158 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
8160 else
8162 switch (cursor_type)
8164 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
8165 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
8166 break;
8168 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
8169 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
8170 break;
8172 case BAR_CURSOR:
8173 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
8174 break;
8176 case HBAR_CURSOR:
8177 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
8178 break;
8180 case NO_CURSOR:
8181 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
8182 break;
8184 default:
8185 emacs_abort ();
8189 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8190 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
8191 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
8192 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
8193 #endif
8196 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8200 /* Icons. */
8202 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
8204 bool
8205 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
8207 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
8209 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
8210 return true;
8212 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
8213 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
8214 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
8215 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
8217 if (STRINGP (file))
8219 #ifdef USE_GTK
8220 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
8221 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
8222 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
8223 return false;
8224 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8225 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
8226 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
8228 else
8230 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
8231 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
8233 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
8235 #ifdef USE_GTK
8237 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id == -2
8238 || xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
8239 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
8241 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = -2;
8242 return false;
8245 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
8247 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
8248 if (rc != -1)
8249 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
8251 #endif
8253 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
8254 if (rc == -1)
8256 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
8257 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
8258 if (rc == -1)
8259 return true;
8261 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
8262 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
8266 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
8267 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
8268 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
8269 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
8270 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
8272 bitmap_id = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
8275 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
8276 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
8278 return false;
8282 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
8283 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
8285 bool
8286 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
8288 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
8289 return true;
8292 XTextProperty text;
8293 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
8294 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
8295 text.format = 8;
8296 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
8297 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
8300 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
8301 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
8302 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
8303 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
8305 return false;
8308 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
8310 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
8311 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
8313 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
8314 be called from a signal handler.
8317 struct x_error_message_stack {
8318 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
8319 Display *dpy;
8320 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
8322 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
8324 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
8325 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
8326 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
8328 static void
8329 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
8331 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
8332 x_error_message->string,
8333 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
8336 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
8337 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
8338 operating on.
8340 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
8341 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
8342 stored in *x_error_message.
8344 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
8345 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
8347 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
8349 void
8350 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
8352 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
8354 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
8355 XSync (dpy, False);
8357 data->dpy = dpy;
8358 data->string[0] = 0;
8359 data->prev = x_error_message;
8360 x_error_message = data;
8363 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
8364 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
8366 void
8367 x_uncatch_errors (void)
8369 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
8371 block_input ();
8373 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
8374 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
8375 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
8376 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
8378 tmp = x_error_message;
8379 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
8380 xfree (tmp);
8381 unblock_input ();
8384 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
8385 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
8386 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
8388 void
8389 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
8391 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8392 XSync (dpy, False);
8394 if (x_error_message->string[0])
8396 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
8397 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
8398 x_uncatch_errors ();
8399 error (format, string);
8403 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
8404 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8406 bool
8407 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
8409 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8410 XSync (dpy, False);
8412 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
8415 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8417 void
8418 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
8420 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
8423 #if false
8424 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
8425 * idea. --lorentey */
8426 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
8428 void
8429 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
8431 while (x_error_message)
8432 x_uncatch_errors ();
8434 #endif
8436 #if false
8437 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
8438 x_trace_wire (void)
8440 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
8442 #endif
8445 /************************************************************************
8446 Handling X errors
8447 ************************************************************************/
8449 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
8451 static char *error_msg;
8453 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
8454 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
8456 static void
8457 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
8459 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
8460 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8461 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
8463 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
8464 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
8466 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
8467 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
8469 if (dpyinfo)
8471 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
8472 frame on it. */
8473 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
8474 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
8477 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
8478 that are on the dead display. */
8479 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8481 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
8482 minibuf_frame
8483 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
8484 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
8485 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
8486 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
8487 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
8488 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
8491 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
8492 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
8493 for another frame that we need to delete. */
8494 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8495 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
8496 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
8498 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
8499 trying to find a replacement. */
8500 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
8501 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
8504 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
8505 first place, so don't try to close it. */
8506 if (dpyinfo)
8508 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
8509 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
8510 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
8511 #ifdef USE_GTK
8512 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
8513 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
8514 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
8515 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
8516 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
8517 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
8518 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
8519 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
8520 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
8521 error_msg);
8522 emacs_abort ();
8523 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8525 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
8526 dpyinfo->display = 0;
8528 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
8529 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
8530 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
8531 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
8532 emacs_abort ();
8535 Lisp_Object tmp;
8536 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
8537 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
8541 if (terminal_list == 0)
8543 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
8544 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
8545 /* NOTREACHED */
8548 totally_unblock_input ();
8550 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
8551 clear_waiting_for_input ();
8553 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
8554 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
8556 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
8557 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
8558 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
8559 error ("%s", error_msg);
8562 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
8563 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
8564 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
8566 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
8567 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
8569 static int
8570 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
8572 #if defined USE_GTK && defined HAVE_GTK3
8573 if ((event->error_code == BadMatch || event->error_code == BadWindow)
8574 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus)
8576 return 0;
8578 #endif
8580 if (x_error_message)
8581 x_error_catcher (display, event);
8582 else
8583 x_error_quitter (display, event);
8584 return 0;
8587 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
8588 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
8589 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8591 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
8593 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
8594 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
8596 static void NO_INLINE
8597 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
8599 char buf[256], buf1[356];
8601 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
8602 or colors that are not defined. */
8604 if (event->error_code == BadName)
8605 return;
8607 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
8608 original error handler. */
8610 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
8611 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
8612 buf, event->request_code);
8613 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
8617 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
8618 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
8619 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8621 static int
8622 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
8624 char buf[256];
8626 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
8627 DisplayString (display));
8628 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
8629 return 0;
8632 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
8634 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
8635 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
8636 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
8637 FONT-OBJECT. */
8639 Lisp_Object
8640 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
8642 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
8643 int unit;
8645 if (fontset < 0)
8646 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
8647 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
8648 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
8649 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8650 do. */
8651 return font_object;
8653 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
8654 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
8655 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
8656 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
8658 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8659 FRAME_MENU_BAR_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
8660 #endif
8662 /* Compute character columns occupied by scrollbar.
8664 Don't do things differently for non-toolkit scrollbars
8665 (Bug#17163). */
8666 unit = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8667 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8668 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8669 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + unit - 1) / unit;
8670 else
8671 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + unit - 1) / unit;
8673 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8675 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8676 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8677 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8678 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8679 adjust_frame_size (f, FRAME_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f),
8680 FRAME_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), 3,
8681 false, Qfont);
8684 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8685 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8686 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8688 block_input ();
8689 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8690 unblock_input ();
8692 #endif
8694 return font_object;
8698 /***********************************************************************
8699 X Input Methods
8700 ***********************************************************************/
8702 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8704 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8706 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8707 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8708 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8710 static void
8711 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8713 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8714 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8716 block_input ();
8718 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8719 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8721 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8722 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8724 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8725 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8729 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8730 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8731 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8732 unblock_input ();
8735 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8737 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8738 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8740 static void
8741 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8743 XIM xim;
8745 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8746 if (use_xim)
8748 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8749 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8750 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8751 emacs_class);
8752 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8754 if (xim)
8756 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8757 XIMCallback destroy;
8758 #endif
8760 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8761 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8763 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8764 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8765 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8766 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8767 #endif
8771 else
8772 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8773 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8777 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8779 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8780 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8781 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8782 when the callback was registered. */
8784 static void
8785 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8787 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8788 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8790 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8791 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8792 return;
8794 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8796 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8797 as they have no XIC. */
8798 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8800 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8802 block_input ();
8803 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8805 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8807 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8808 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8809 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8811 create_frame_xic (f);
8812 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8813 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8814 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8816 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8817 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8822 unblock_input ();
8826 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8829 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8830 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8831 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8832 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8834 static void
8835 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8837 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8838 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8839 if (use_xim)
8841 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8842 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8843 Bool ret;
8845 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8846 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8847 xim_inst->resource_name = xstrdup (resource_name);
8848 ret = XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback
8849 (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, xim_inst->resource_name,
8850 emacs_class, xim_instantiate_callback,
8851 /* This is XPointer in XFree86 but (XPointer *)
8852 on Tru64, at least, hence the configure test. */
8853 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8854 eassert (ret == True);
8855 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8856 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8857 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8859 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8863 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8865 static void
8866 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8868 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8869 if (use_xim)
8871 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8872 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = dpyinfo->xim_callback_data;
8874 if (dpyinfo->display)
8876 Bool ret = XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback
8877 (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, xim_inst->resource_name,
8878 emacs_class, xim_instantiate_callback,
8879 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8880 eassert (ret == True);
8882 xfree (xim_inst->resource_name);
8883 xfree (xim_inst);
8884 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8885 if (dpyinfo->display)
8886 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8887 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8888 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8890 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8893 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8897 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8898 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8900 static void
8901 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8903 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8905 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8906 is already for the top-left corner. */
8907 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8908 return;
8910 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8911 position that fits on the screen. */
8912 if (flags & XNegative)
8913 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8914 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8917 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8919 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8920 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8921 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8923 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8924 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8925 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8926 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8927 is right, though.
8929 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8930 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8932 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8933 #endif
8935 if (flags & YNegative)
8936 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8937 - height + f->top_pos;
8940 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8941 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8942 so the flags should correspond. */
8943 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8946 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8947 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8948 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8949 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8950 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8952 void
8953 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8955 int modified_top, modified_left;
8957 if (change_gravity > 0)
8959 f->top_pos = yoff;
8960 f->left_pos = xoff;
8961 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8962 if (xoff < 0)
8963 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8964 if (yoff < 0)
8965 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8966 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8968 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8970 block_input ();
8971 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, false);
8973 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8974 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8976 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8978 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8979 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8980 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8981 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8982 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8985 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8986 modified_left, modified_top);
8988 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8989 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN);
8991 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8992 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8993 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8994 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8995 of the frame.
8997 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8998 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8999 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
9001 if (change_gravity != 0
9002 && (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
9003 || (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
9004 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
9005 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
9006 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
9008 unblock_input ();
9011 /* Return true if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
9012 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
9013 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
9014 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9015 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
9017 static bool
9018 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
9020 Atom actual_type;
9021 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
9022 int i, rc, actual_format;
9023 bool ret;
9024 Window wmcheck_window;
9025 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9026 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
9027 int max_len = 65536;
9028 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
9029 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
9030 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
9032 block_input ();
9034 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9035 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
9036 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
9037 0, max_len, False, target_type,
9038 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
9039 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
9041 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9043 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9044 x_uncatch_errors ();
9045 unblock_input ();
9046 return false;
9049 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
9050 XFree (tmp_data);
9052 /* Check if window exists. */
9053 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
9054 x_sync (f);
9055 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9057 x_uncatch_errors ();
9058 unblock_input ();
9059 return false;
9062 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
9064 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
9065 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
9066 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
9067 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
9068 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
9069 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
9071 target_type = XA_ATOM;
9072 tmp_data = NULL;
9073 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
9074 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
9075 0, max_len, False, target_type,
9076 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
9077 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
9079 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9081 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9082 x_uncatch_errors ();
9083 unblock_input ();
9084 return false;
9087 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
9088 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
9089 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
9092 ret = false;
9094 for (i = 0; !ret && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
9095 ret = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
9097 x_uncatch_errors ();
9098 unblock_input ();
9100 return ret;
9103 static void
9104 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, bool add, Atom atom, Atom value)
9106 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
9108 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9109 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
9110 make_number (32),
9111 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
9112 Fcons
9113 (make_number (add),
9114 Fcons
9115 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
9116 (value != 0
9117 ? list1 (make_fixnum_or_float (value))
9118 : Qnil))));
9121 void
9122 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
9124 Lisp_Object frame;
9125 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9127 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9129 set_wm_state (frame, !NILP (new_value),
9130 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
9133 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
9134 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
9135 Set *STICKY to the sticky state.
9137 Return true iff we are not hidden. */
9139 static bool
9140 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
9141 Window window,
9142 int *size_state,
9143 bool *sticky)
9145 Atom actual_type;
9146 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
9147 int i, rc, actual_format;
9148 bool is_hidden = false;
9149 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9150 long max_len = 65536;
9151 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
9152 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
9153 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
9155 *sticky = false;
9156 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
9158 block_input ();
9159 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9160 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
9161 0, max_len, False, target_type,
9162 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
9163 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
9165 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9167 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9168 x_uncatch_errors ();
9169 unblock_input ();
9170 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
9173 x_uncatch_errors ();
9175 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
9177 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
9178 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
9179 is_hidden = true;
9180 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
9182 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
9183 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
9184 else
9185 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
9187 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
9189 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
9190 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
9191 else
9192 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
9194 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
9195 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
9196 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
9197 *sticky = true;
9200 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9201 unblock_input ();
9202 return ! is_hidden;
9205 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
9207 static bool
9208 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
9210 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9211 bool have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
9212 int cur;
9213 bool dummy;
9215 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
9217 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
9218 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
9219 if (!have_net_atom)
9220 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
9222 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
9224 Lisp_Object frame;
9226 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9228 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
9229 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
9230 are sent at once. */
9231 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
9233 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
9234 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
9235 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
9236 set_wm_state (frame, false,
9237 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
9238 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
9239 set_wm_state (frame, true,
9240 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
9241 break;
9242 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
9243 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
9244 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
9245 set_wm_state (frame, false, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
9246 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
9247 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
9248 set_wm_state (frame, true,
9249 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
9250 break;
9251 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
9252 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
9253 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
9254 set_wm_state (frame, false, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
9255 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
9256 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
9257 set_wm_state (frame, true,
9258 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
9259 break;
9260 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
9261 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
9262 set_wm_state (frame, false, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
9263 None);
9264 set_wm_state (frame, true,
9265 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
9266 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
9267 break;
9268 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
9269 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
9270 set_wm_state (frame, false, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
9271 None);
9272 else
9273 set_wm_state (frame, false,
9274 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
9275 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
9278 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
9282 return have_net_atom;
9285 static void
9286 XTfullscreen_hook (struct frame *f)
9288 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9290 block_input ();
9291 x_check_fullscreen (f);
9292 x_sync (f);
9293 unblock_input ();
9298 static bool
9299 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, const XPropertyEvent *event)
9301 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
9302 Lisp_Object lval;
9303 bool sticky = false;
9304 bool not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
9306 lval = Qnil;
9307 switch (value)
9309 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
9310 lval = Qfullwidth;
9311 break;
9312 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
9313 lval = Qfullheight;
9314 break;
9315 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
9316 lval = Qfullboth;
9317 break;
9318 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
9319 lval = Qmaximized;
9320 break;
9323 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
9324 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
9326 return not_hidden;
9329 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
9330 If so needed, resize the frame. */
9331 static void
9332 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
9334 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
9335 return;
9337 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
9338 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
9340 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
9341 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
9342 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
9344 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
9346 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9349 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
9351 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
9352 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
9353 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
9354 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
9355 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
9356 break;
9357 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
9358 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
9359 break;
9360 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
9361 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
9364 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9365 width, height);
9369 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
9370 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
9371 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
9372 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
9373 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
9374 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
9375 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
9377 static void
9378 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
9380 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
9382 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
9383 window manager window around the frame. */
9385 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
9387 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
9389 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
9391 int adjusted_left;
9392 int adjusted_top;
9394 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
9395 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
9396 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
9398 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
9400 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
9401 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
9403 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9404 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
9406 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, false);
9408 else
9409 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
9410 frame's position. */
9412 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
9416 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
9417 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
9418 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
9419 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
9420 of an exact comparison. */
9422 static void
9423 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, bool fuzzy)
9425 int count = 0;
9427 while (count++ < 50)
9429 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
9431 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
9432 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
9433 loop. */
9435 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9436 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
9438 if (fuzzy)
9440 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
9441 pixels. */
9443 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
9444 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
9445 return;
9447 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
9448 return;
9451 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
9452 will then return up-to-date position info. */
9454 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000000, 0, false, Qnil, NULL, 0);
9458 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
9459 void
9460 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
9462 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
9464 fd_set fds;
9465 struct timespec tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
9466 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9468 f->wait_event_type = eventtype;
9470 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
9471 Maybe it should be configurable. */
9472 tmo = make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
9473 tmo_at = timespec_add (current_timespec (), tmo);
9475 while (f->wait_event_type)
9477 pending_signals = true;
9478 totally_unblock_input ();
9479 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
9480 block_input ();
9481 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
9483 FD_ZERO (&fds);
9484 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
9486 time_now = current_timespec ();
9487 if (timespec_cmp (tmo_at, time_now) < 0)
9488 break;
9490 tmo = timespec_sub (tmo_at, time_now);
9491 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
9492 break; /* Timeout */
9495 f->wait_event_type = 0;
9499 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to WIDTH/HEIGHT in the case F
9500 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY, change to
9501 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
9502 size changes. Otherwise leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9504 static void
9505 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, bool change_gravity,
9506 int width, int height, bool pixelwise)
9508 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
9510 pixelwidth = (pixelwise
9511 ? FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, width)
9512 : FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, width));
9513 pixelheight = ((pixelwise
9514 ? FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, height)
9515 : FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, height)));
9517 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
9518 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, false);
9519 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9520 pixelwidth, pixelheight + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f));
9523 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
9524 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
9525 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
9526 we have to make sure to do it here. */
9527 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9529 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
9530 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
9531 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
9532 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
9534 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
9535 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
9536 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
9537 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
9538 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
9540 Pass true for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
9541 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
9543 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
9544 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
9545 for the ConfigureNotify. */
9546 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9547 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
9548 else
9550 change_frame_size (f, pixelwidth, pixelheight, false, true, false, true);
9551 x_sync (f);
9556 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
9557 If CHANGE_GRAVITY, change to top-left-corner window gravity
9558 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
9559 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9561 void
9562 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, bool change_gravity,
9563 int width, int height, bool pixelwise)
9565 block_input ();
9567 /* The following breaks our calculations. If it's really needed,
9568 think of something else. */
9569 #if false
9570 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
9572 int text_width, text_height;
9574 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
9575 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
9576 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/width to
9577 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
9578 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
9579 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
9580 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
9581 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9582 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9583 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
9584 is however. */
9585 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9586 #endif
9587 text_width = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
9588 text_height = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f, pixelh);
9590 change_frame_size (f, text_width, text_height, false, true, false, true);
9592 #endif
9594 #ifdef USE_GTK
9595 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
9596 if (! pixelwise)
9597 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, width * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f),
9598 height * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
9599 else
9600 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, width, height);
9601 else
9602 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, width, height, pixelwise);
9603 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9605 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, width, height, pixelwise);
9606 x_clear_under_internal_border (f);
9608 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9610 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
9611 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
9613 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
9614 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
9615 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
9616 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
9617 cancel_mouse_face (f);
9619 unblock_input ();
9621 do_pending_window_change (false);
9624 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
9626 void
9627 frame_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
9629 block_input ();
9631 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9632 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9633 unblock_input ();
9636 /* Raise frame F. */
9638 void
9639 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
9641 block_input ();
9642 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9643 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9644 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9645 unblock_input ();
9648 /* Lower frame F. */
9650 static void
9651 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
9653 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9655 block_input ();
9656 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9657 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9658 unblock_input ();
9662 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9664 void
9665 xembed_request_focus (struct frame *f)
9667 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9668 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9669 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9670 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9671 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9674 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9676 void
9677 x_ewmh_activate_frame (struct frame *f)
9679 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9680 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9682 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9684 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9686 Lisp_Object frame;
9687 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9688 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9689 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9690 make_number (32),
9691 list2i (1, dpyinfo->last_user_time));
9695 static void
9696 XTframe_raise_lower (struct frame *f, bool raise_flag)
9698 if (raise_flag)
9699 x_raise_frame (f);
9700 else
9701 x_lower_frame (f);
9704 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9706 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9708 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9710 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9712 static void
9713 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9715 unsigned long data[2];
9716 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9718 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9719 data[1] = flags;
9721 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9722 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9723 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9725 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9727 static void
9728 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9729 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9731 XEvent event;
9733 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9734 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9735 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9736 event.xclient.format = 32;
9737 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9738 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9739 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9740 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9741 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9743 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9744 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9745 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9748 /* Change of visibility. */
9750 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9751 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9752 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9753 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9754 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9755 finishes with it. */
9757 void
9758 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9760 int original_top, original_left;
9761 int tries = 0;
9763 block_input ();
9765 x_set_bitmap_icon (f);
9767 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9769 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9770 call x_set_offset a second time
9771 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9772 before the window gets really visible. */
9773 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9774 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9775 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9776 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9778 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = true;
9780 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9781 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9782 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9783 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9784 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9785 else
9787 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9788 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9790 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9791 #ifdef USE_GTK
9792 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9793 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9794 #else
9795 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9796 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9797 else
9798 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9799 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9800 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9803 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9805 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9806 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9807 so that incoming events are handled. */
9809 Lisp_Object frame;
9810 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9811 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9812 will set it when they are handled. */
9813 bool previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9815 original_left = f->left_pos;
9816 original_top = f->top_pos;
9818 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9819 unblock_input ();
9821 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9823 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9824 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9825 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9826 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9828 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9829 because the window manager may choose the position
9830 and we don't want to override it. */
9832 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9833 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9834 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9835 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9836 && previously_visible)
9838 Drawable rootw;
9839 int x, y;
9840 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9842 block_input ();
9844 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9845 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9846 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9847 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9848 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9849 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9850 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9851 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9852 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9854 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9855 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9856 original_left, original_top);
9858 unblock_input ();
9861 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9863 /* Process X events until a MapNotify event has been seen. */
9864 while (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9866 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9867 x_sync (f);
9869 /* If on another desktop, the deiconify/map may be ignored and the
9870 frame never becomes visible. XMonad does this.
9871 Prevent an endless loop. */
9872 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) && ++tries > 100)
9873 break;
9875 /* This hack is still in use at least for Cygwin. See
9876 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2013-12/msg00351.html.
9878 Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9879 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9880 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9881 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9882 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9883 probably a bug. */
9884 if (input_polling_used ())
9886 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9887 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9888 handler reset it. */
9889 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9890 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9891 poll_for_input_1 ();
9892 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9895 if (XPending (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9897 XEvent xev;
9898 XNextEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), &xev);
9899 x_dispatch_event (&xev, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9905 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9907 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9909 void
9910 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9912 Window window;
9914 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9915 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9917 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9918 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9919 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9921 block_input ();
9923 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9924 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9925 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9926 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9927 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9928 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, true);
9930 #ifdef USE_GTK
9931 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9932 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9933 else
9934 #else
9935 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9936 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9937 else
9938 #endif
9941 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9942 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9944 unblock_input ();
9945 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9949 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9950 just by the event that we get from the server.
9951 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9952 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9953 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9954 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9955 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, false);
9957 x_sync (f);
9959 unblock_input ();
9962 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9964 void
9965 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9967 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9968 int result;
9969 #endif
9971 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9972 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9973 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9975 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9976 return;
9978 block_input ();
9980 x_set_bitmap_icon (f);
9982 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9983 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9985 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9986 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9988 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9989 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9990 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
9991 unblock_input ();
9992 return;
9994 #endif
9996 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9998 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10000 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
10001 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
10002 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
10003 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
10004 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
10005 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
10006 so we have to record it here. */
10007 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
10008 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
10009 unblock_input ();
10010 return;
10013 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10014 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
10015 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
10016 unblock_input ();
10018 if (!result)
10019 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
10021 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
10022 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
10024 block_input ();
10025 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10026 unblock_input ();
10027 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10029 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
10030 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
10031 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
10032 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
10033 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
10034 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
10036 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
10037 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
10039 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
10040 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
10042 XEvent msg;
10044 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10045 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
10046 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
10047 msg.xclient.format = 32;
10048 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
10050 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10051 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
10052 False,
10053 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
10054 &msg))
10056 unblock_input ();
10057 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
10061 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
10062 IconicState. */
10063 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
10065 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10067 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
10068 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10071 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
10072 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
10074 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10075 unblock_input ();
10076 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10080 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
10082 void
10083 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
10085 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10086 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10087 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10088 Lisp_Object bar;
10089 struct scroll_bar *b;
10090 #endif
10092 block_input ();
10094 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
10095 commands to the X server. */
10096 if (dpyinfo->display)
10098 /* Always exit with visible pointer to avoid weird issue
10099 with Xfixes (Bug#17609). */
10100 if (f->pointer_invisible)
10101 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->toggle_visible_pointer (f, 0);
10103 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
10104 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
10105 face. */
10106 free_frame_faces (f);
10108 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
10109 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
10111 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10112 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
10113 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
10114 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
10115 toolkit scroll bars. */
10116 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
10118 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
10119 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
10121 #endif
10123 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10124 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
10125 free_frame_xic (f);
10126 #endif
10128 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10129 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
10131 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
10132 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
10134 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
10135 we are using a toolkit. */
10136 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
10137 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10139 free_frame_menubar (f);
10141 if (f->shell_position)
10142 xfree (f->shell_position);
10143 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10145 #ifdef USE_GTK
10146 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
10147 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10149 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
10150 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10151 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10153 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
10154 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
10155 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
10156 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
10157 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
10158 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
10160 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
10161 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
10162 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
10163 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
10164 #if defined (USE_LUCID) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
10165 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
10166 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
10167 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
10168 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
10169 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
10170 #endif /* USE_LUCID && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10171 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel != -1)
10172 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
10173 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel != -1)
10174 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
10176 x_free_gcs (f);
10178 /* Free extra GCs allocated by x_setup_relief_colors. */
10179 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc)
10181 XFreeGC (dpyinfo->display, f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc);
10182 f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc = 0;
10184 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc)
10186 XFreeGC (dpyinfo->display, f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc);
10187 f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc = 0;
10190 /* Free cursors. */
10191 if (f->output_data.x->text_cursor != 0)
10192 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
10193 if (f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor != 0)
10194 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
10195 if (f->output_data.x->modeline_cursor != 0)
10196 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->modeline_cursor);
10197 if (f->output_data.x->hand_cursor != 0)
10198 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->hand_cursor);
10199 if (f->output_data.x->hourglass_cursor != 0)
10200 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->hourglass_cursor);
10201 if (f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor != 0)
10202 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor);
10203 if (f->output_data.x->vertical_drag_cursor != 0)
10204 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->vertical_drag_cursor);
10206 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10209 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
10210 xfree (f->output_data.x);
10211 f->output_data.x = NULL;
10213 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10214 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10215 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
10216 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10217 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
10218 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10219 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
10220 reset_mouse_highlight (hlinfo);
10222 unblock_input ();
10226 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
10228 static void
10229 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
10231 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10233 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
10234 commands to the X server. */
10235 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
10236 x_free_frame_resources (f);
10238 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
10242 /* Setting window manager hints. */
10244 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
10245 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
10246 that the window now has.
10247 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
10248 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
10249 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
10251 #ifndef USE_GTK
10252 void
10253 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
10255 XSizeHints size_hints;
10256 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10258 if (!window)
10259 return;
10261 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10262 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
10264 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
10265 return;
10267 #endif
10269 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
10270 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
10272 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
10273 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
10275 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
10276 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
10278 size_hints.width_inc = frame_resize_pixelwise ? 1 : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
10279 size_hints.height_inc = frame_resize_pixelwise ? 1 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10281 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
10282 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
10283 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
10284 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
10286 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
10288 int base_width, base_height;
10289 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
10291 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
10292 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
10294 if (frame_resize_pixelwise)
10295 /* Needed to prevent a bad protocol error crash when making the
10296 frame size very small. */
10298 min_cols = 2 * min_cols;
10299 min_rows = 2 * min_rows;
10302 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
10303 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
10304 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
10305 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
10306 zero-row, zero-column frame.
10308 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
10309 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
10310 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
10312 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
10313 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
10314 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
10315 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
10316 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10319 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
10320 if (flags)
10322 size_hints.flags |= flags;
10323 goto no_read;
10327 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
10328 long supplied_return;
10329 int value;
10331 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
10332 &supplied_return);
10334 if (flags)
10335 size_hints.flags |= flags;
10336 else
10338 if (value == 0)
10339 hints.flags = 0;
10340 if (hints.flags & PSize)
10341 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
10342 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
10343 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
10344 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
10345 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10346 if (hints.flags & USSize)
10347 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
10351 no_read:
10353 #ifdef PWinGravity
10354 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
10355 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
10357 if (user_position)
10359 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
10360 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10362 #endif /* PWinGravity */
10364 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
10366 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
10368 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
10370 static void
10371 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
10373 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10374 Arg al[1];
10376 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
10377 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10378 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10379 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10381 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
10382 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
10384 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10385 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10388 static void
10389 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
10391 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
10393 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
10394 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10395 #endif
10397 if (pixmap_id > 0)
10399 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
10400 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
10401 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
10402 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
10404 else
10406 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
10407 pixmap. */
10408 return;
10412 #ifdef USE_GTK
10414 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
10415 return;
10418 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
10421 Arg al[1];
10422 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
10423 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10424 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
10425 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10428 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10430 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
10431 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10433 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10436 void
10437 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
10439 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10441 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
10442 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
10443 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
10445 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10449 /***********************************************************************
10450 Fonts
10451 ***********************************************************************/
10453 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
10455 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
10456 font table. */
10458 static void
10459 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
10461 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
10462 if (font->driver->check)
10463 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
10466 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
10469 /***********************************************************************
10470 Initialization
10471 ***********************************************************************/
10473 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10474 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10475 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10476 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10478 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10479 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10480 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10482 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10483 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10484 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10485 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10486 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10487 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10488 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10491 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10493 static bool x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
10495 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10497 static int x_initialized;
10499 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10500 the screen number from the server number. */
10501 static bool
10502 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
10504 bool seen_colon = false;
10505 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
10506 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
10507 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
10509 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10510 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10511 length_until_period++;
10513 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10514 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10515 name1 += 4;
10516 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10517 name2 += 4;
10518 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10519 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10520 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10521 name1 += system_name_length;
10522 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10523 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10524 name2 += system_name_length;
10525 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10526 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10527 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10528 name1 += length_until_period;
10529 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10530 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10531 name2 += length_until_period;
10533 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10535 if (*name1 == ':')
10536 seen_colon = true;
10537 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10538 return true;
10540 return (seen_colon
10541 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10542 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10545 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10546 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10547 to 5. */
10548 static void
10549 get_bits_and_offset (unsigned long mask, int *bits, int *offset)
10551 int nr = 0;
10552 int off = 0;
10554 while (!(mask & 1))
10556 off++;
10557 mask >>= 1;
10560 while (mask & 1)
10562 nr++;
10563 mask >>= 1;
10566 *offset = off;
10567 *bits = nr;
10570 /* Return true iff display DISPLAY is available for use.
10571 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
10573 bool
10574 x_display_ok (const char *display)
10576 Display *dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10577 if (!dpy)
10578 return false;
10579 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
10580 return true;
10583 #ifdef USE_GTK
10584 static void
10585 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
10586 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
10588 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
10589 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
10591 #endif
10593 /* Create invisible cursor on X display referred by DPYINFO. */
10595 static Cursor
10596 make_invisible_cursor (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10598 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10599 static char const no_data[] = { 0 };
10600 Pixmap pix;
10601 XColor col;
10602 Cursor c = 0;
10604 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10605 pix = XCreateBitmapFromData (dpy, dpyinfo->root_window, no_data, 1, 1);
10606 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy) && pix != None)
10608 Cursor pixc;
10609 col.pixel = 0;
10610 col.red = col.green = col.blue = 0;
10611 col.flags = DoRed | DoGreen | DoBlue;
10612 pixc = XCreatePixmapCursor (dpy, pix, pix, &col, &col, 0, 0);
10613 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy) && pixc != None)
10614 c = pixc;
10615 XFreePixmap (dpy, pix);
10618 x_uncatch_errors ();
10620 return c;
10623 /* True if DPY supports Xfixes extension >= 4. */
10625 static bool
10626 x_probe_xfixes_extension (Display *dpy)
10628 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
10629 int major, minor;
10630 return XFixesQueryVersion (dpy, &major, &minor) && major >= 4;
10631 #else
10632 return false;
10633 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
10636 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using Xfixes functions. */
10638 static void
10639 xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame *f, bool invisible)
10641 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
10642 if (invisible)
10643 XFixesHideCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10644 else
10645 XFixesShowCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10646 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
10647 #else
10648 emacs_abort ();
10649 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
10652 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using invisible cursor. */
10654 static void
10655 x_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame *f, bool invisible)
10657 eassert (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0);
10658 if (invisible)
10659 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
10660 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
10661 else
10662 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
10663 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
10664 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
10667 /* Setup pointer blanking, prefer Xfixes if available. */
10669 static void
10670 x_setup_pointer_blanking (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10672 /* FIXME: the brave tester should set EMACS_XFIXES because we're suspecting
10673 X server bug, see http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=17609. */
10674 if (egetenv ("EMACS_XFIXES") && x_probe_xfixes_extension (dpyinfo->display))
10675 dpyinfo->toggle_visible_pointer = xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer;
10676 else
10678 dpyinfo->toggle_visible_pointer = x_toggle_visible_pointer;
10679 dpyinfo->invisible_cursor = make_invisible_cursor (dpyinfo);
10683 /* Current X display connection identifier. Incremented for each next
10684 connection established. */
10685 static unsigned x_display_id;
10687 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
10688 the structure that describes the open display.
10689 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
10691 struct x_display_info *
10692 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
10694 Display *dpy;
10695 struct terminal *terminal;
10696 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10697 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10698 ptrdiff_t lim;
10700 block_input ();
10702 if (!x_initialized)
10704 x_initialize ();
10705 ++x_initialized;
10708 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
10709 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
10711 #ifdef USE_GTK
10713 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10714 int argc;
10715 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10716 char **argv2 = argv;
10717 guint id;
10719 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10721 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
10723 else
10725 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
10726 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
10728 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10729 argv[argc] = 0;
10731 argc = 0;
10732 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10734 if (! NILP (display_name))
10736 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
10737 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
10740 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
10741 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10743 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10745 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10746 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10747 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10748 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
10750 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10751 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10752 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10754 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
10755 fixup_locale ();
10756 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10757 fixup_locale ();
10759 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
10761 xg_initialize ();
10763 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10765 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
10766 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10768 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10769 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10771 s = build_string (file);
10772 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10774 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10775 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10777 #endif
10779 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10780 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10783 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10784 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10785 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10786 errors with X11R5:
10787 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10788 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10789 So let's not use it until R6. */
10790 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10791 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10792 #endif
10795 int argc = 0;
10796 char *argv[3];
10798 argv[0] = "";
10799 argc = 1;
10800 if (xrm_option)
10802 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10803 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10805 turn_on_atimers (false);
10806 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10807 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10808 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10809 &argc, argv);
10810 turn_on_atimers (true);
10812 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10813 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10814 fixup_locale ();
10815 #endif
10818 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10819 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10820 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10821 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10822 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10824 /* Detect failure. */
10825 if (dpy == 0)
10827 unblock_input ();
10828 return 0;
10831 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10833 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10834 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10837 struct x_display_info *share;
10839 for (share = x_display_list; share; share = share->next)
10840 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (share->name_list_element)),
10841 SSDATA (display_name)))
10842 break;
10843 if (share)
10844 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10845 else
10847 terminal->kboard = allocate_kboard (Qx);
10849 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10851 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10853 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10854 list of terminals. */
10855 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10856 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10857 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10858 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10860 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10861 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10862 unblock_input ();
10863 kset_system_key_alist
10864 (terminal->kboard,
10865 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10866 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10867 block_input ();
10868 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10869 terminal_list = terminal;
10870 UNGCPRO;
10873 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10874 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10875 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10876 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10877 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10879 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10882 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10883 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10884 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10886 dpyinfo->name_list_element = Fcons (display_name, Qnil);
10887 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10888 dpyinfo->connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10890 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10891 terminal->name = xlispstrdup (display_name);
10893 #if false
10894 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10895 #endif
10897 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10898 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10899 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10900 dpyinfo->x_id = ++x_display_id;
10901 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10902 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10903 char *nametail = lispstpcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, Vinvocation_name);
10904 *nametail++ = '@';
10905 lispstpcpy (nametail, Vsystem_name);
10907 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10908 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10910 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10911 #ifdef USE_GTK
10912 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10913 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10914 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10916 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10917 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10919 dpyinfo->horizontal_scroll_bar_cursor
10920 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_h_double_arrow);
10922 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10923 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10924 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10925 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10926 #else
10927 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10928 #endif
10929 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10930 all versions. */
10931 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10933 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10934 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10935 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10936 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10937 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10938 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10939 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10941 reset_mouse_highlight (&dpyinfo->mouse_highlight);
10943 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10944 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10946 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10947 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10948 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10949 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10950 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10951 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10954 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10955 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10957 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10959 AUTO_STRING (privateColormap, "privateColormap");
10960 AUTO_STRING (PrivateColormap, "PrivateColormap");
10961 Lisp_Object value
10962 = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo, privateColormap,
10963 PrivateColormap, Qnil, Qnil);
10964 if (STRINGP (value)
10965 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10966 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10967 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10970 else
10971 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10972 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10974 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10976 /* If we are using Xft, the following precautions should be made:
10978 1. Make sure that the Xrender extension is added before the Xft one.
10979 Otherwise, the close-display hook set by Xft is called after the one
10980 for Xrender, and the former tries to re-add the latter. This results
10981 in inconsistency of internal states and leads to X protocol error when
10982 one reconnects to the same X server (Bug#1696).
10984 2. Check dpi value in X resources. It is better we use it as well,
10985 since Xft will use it, as will all Gnome applications. If our real DPI
10986 is smaller or larger than the one Xft uses, our font will look smaller
10987 or larger than other for other applications, even if it is the same
10988 font name (monospace-10 for example). */
10990 int event_base, error_base;
10991 char *v;
10992 double d;
10994 XRenderQueryExtension (dpyinfo->display, &event_base, &error_base);
10996 v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10997 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10998 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
11000 #endif
11002 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
11004 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11005 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11006 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11007 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11008 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
11009 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11010 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11011 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11012 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
11016 static const struct
11018 const char *name;
11019 int offset;
11020 } atom_refs[] = {
11021 #define ATOM_REFS_INIT(string, member) \
11022 { string, offsetof (struct x_display_info, member) },
11023 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_PROTOCOLS", Xatom_wm_protocols)
11024 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_TAKE_FOCUS", Xatom_wm_take_focus)
11025 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
11026 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_DELETE_WINDOW", Xatom_wm_delete_window)
11027 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CHANGE_STATE", Xatom_wm_change_state)
11028 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
11029 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_MOVED", Xatom_wm_window_moved)
11030 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CLIENT_LEADER", Xatom_wm_client_leader)
11031 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("Editres", Xatom_editres)
11032 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD", Xatom_CLIPBOARD)
11033 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TIMESTAMP", Xatom_TIMESTAMP)
11034 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TEXT", Xatom_TEXT)
11035 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("COMPOUND_TEXT", Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT)
11036 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("UTF8_STRING", Xatom_UTF8_STRING)
11037 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DELETE", Xatom_DELETE)
11038 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MULTIPLE", Xatom_MULTIPLE)
11039 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("INCR", Xatom_INCR)
11040 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_EMACS_TMP_", Xatom_EMACS_TMP)
11041 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TARGETS", Xatom_TARGETS)
11042 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("NULL", Xatom_NULL)
11043 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM", Xatom_ATOM)
11044 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM_PAIR", Xatom_ATOM_PAIR)
11045 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER)
11046 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED_INFO", Xatom_XEMBED_INFO)
11047 /* For properties of font. */
11048 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PIXEL_SIZE", Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE)
11049 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("AVERAGE_WIDTH", Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH)
11050 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET)
11051 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE)
11052 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT)
11053 /* Ghostscript support. */
11054 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DONE", Xatom_DONE)
11055 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PAGE", Xatom_PAGE)
11056 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Scrollbar)
11057 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("HORIZONTAL_SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar)
11058 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED", Xatom_XEMBED)
11059 /* EWMH */
11060 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE", Xatom_net_wm_state)
11061 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
11062 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
11063 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
11064 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
11065 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
11066 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
11067 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
11068 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", Xatom_net_window_type)
11069 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
11070 Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip)
11071 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_icon_name)
11072 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_name)
11073 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTED", Xatom_net_supported)
11074 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check)
11075 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity)
11076 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", Xatom_net_active_window)
11077 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", Xatom_net_frame_extents)
11078 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", Xatom_net_current_desktop)
11079 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WORKAREA", Xatom_net_workarea)
11080 /* Session management */
11081 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SM_CLIENT_ID", Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID)
11082 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", Xatom_xsettings_prop)
11083 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MANAGER", Xatom_xsettings_mgr)
11086 int i;
11087 enum { atom_count = ARRAYELTS (atom_refs) };
11088 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN. */
11089 enum { total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count };
11090 Atom atoms_return[total_atom_count];
11091 char *atom_names[total_atom_count];
11092 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
11093 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
11094 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
11096 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
11097 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
11099 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name. */
11100 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
11101 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
11102 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
11104 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
11105 False, atoms_return);
11107 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
11108 *(Atom *) ((char *) dpyinfo + atom_refs[i].offset) = atoms_return[i];
11110 /* Manually copy last atom. */
11111 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
11114 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
11115 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
11116 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
11117 dpyinfo->gray
11118 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11119 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
11120 1, 0, 1);
11122 x_setup_pointer_blanking (dpyinfo);
11124 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11125 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
11126 #endif
11128 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
11130 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
11131 if (dpyinfo->connection != 0)
11132 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
11134 #ifdef F_SETOWN
11135 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
11136 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
11138 if (interrupt_input)
11139 init_sigio (dpyinfo->connection);
11141 #ifdef USE_LUCID
11143 XrmValue d, fr, to;
11144 Font font;
11146 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
11147 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
11148 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
11149 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
11150 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
11151 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
11152 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
11153 x_catch_errors (dpy);
11154 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
11155 emacs_abort ();
11156 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
11157 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
11158 /* Do not free XFontStruct returned by the above call to XQueryFont.
11159 This leads to X protocol errors at XtCloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
11160 x_uncatch_errors ();
11162 #endif
11164 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
11165 for debugging X code. */
11167 AUTO_STRING (synchronous, "synchronous");
11168 AUTO_STRING (Synchronous, "Synchronous");
11169 Lisp_Object value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo, synchronous,
11170 Synchronous, Qnil, Qnil);
11171 if (STRINGP (value)
11172 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
11173 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
11174 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
11178 AUTO_STRING (useXIM, "useXIM");
11179 AUTO_STRING (UseXIM, "UseXIM");
11180 Lisp_Object value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo, useXIM, UseXIM,
11181 Qnil, Qnil);
11182 #ifdef USE_XIM
11183 if (STRINGP (value)
11184 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
11185 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
11186 use_xim = false;
11187 #else
11188 if (STRINGP (value)
11189 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
11190 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
11191 use_xim = true;
11192 #endif
11195 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11196 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
11197 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
11198 tty or started as a daemon. */
11199 if (terminal->id == 1 && ! IS_DAEMON)
11200 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
11201 #endif
11203 unblock_input ();
11205 return dpyinfo;
11208 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
11209 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
11211 static void
11212 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
11214 struct terminal *t;
11216 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
11217 X display. */
11218 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
11219 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
11221 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11222 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
11223 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
11224 x_session_close ();
11225 #endif
11226 delete_terminal (t);
11227 break;
11230 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
11231 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
11233 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
11234 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
11235 else
11237 struct x_display_info *tail;
11239 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
11240 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
11241 tail->next = tail->next->next;
11244 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
11245 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
11246 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
11247 xfree (dpyinfo);
11250 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11252 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11253 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11254 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11255 that slows us down. */
11257 static void
11258 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
11260 block_input ();
11261 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = false;
11262 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
11264 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
11265 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
11266 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11267 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11269 unblock_input ();
11272 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11273 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11274 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11275 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11276 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11277 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11278 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11280 void
11281 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
11283 block_input ();
11284 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
11286 struct timespec interval = make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
11287 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
11288 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = true;
11290 unblock_input ();
11293 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11296 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11298 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11300 x_frame_parm_handlers,
11301 x_produce_glyphs,
11302 x_write_glyphs,
11303 x_insert_glyphs,
11304 x_clear_end_of_line,
11305 x_scroll_run,
11306 x_after_update_window_line,
11307 x_update_window_begin,
11308 x_update_window_end,
11309 x_flush,
11310 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
11311 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11312 x_fix_overlapping_area,
11313 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
11314 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11315 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11316 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
11317 x_draw_glyph_string,
11318 x_define_frame_cursor,
11319 x_clear_frame_area,
11320 x_draw_window_cursor,
11321 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
11322 x_draw_window_divider,
11323 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert,
11324 x_show_hourglass,
11325 x_hide_hourglass
11329 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
11330 void
11331 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
11333 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
11335 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
11336 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
11337 if (!terminal->name)
11338 return;
11340 block_input ();
11341 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11342 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
11343 X display. */
11344 if (dpyinfo->xim)
11345 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
11346 #endif
11348 /* Normally, the display is available... */
11349 if (dpyinfo->display)
11351 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
11352 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
11354 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
11355 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
11356 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
11357 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
11359 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
11360 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
11361 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
11362 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
11363 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
11364 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
11365 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
11366 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
11367 leaks in other situations. */
11368 #if false
11369 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
11370 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
11371 #else
11372 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
11373 #endif
11374 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
11375 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
11376 closing all the displays. */
11377 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
11378 #endif
11380 #ifdef USE_GTK
11381 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
11382 #else
11383 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11384 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
11385 #else
11386 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
11387 #endif
11388 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
11389 /* Do not close the connection here because it's already closed
11390 by X(t)CloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
11391 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
11394 /* ...but if called from x_connection_closed, the display may already
11395 be closed and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. Since
11396 X server is most likely gone, explicit close is the only reliable
11397 way to continue and avoid Bug#19147. */
11398 else if (dpyinfo->connection >= 0)
11399 emacs_close (dpyinfo->connection);
11401 /* No more input on this descriptor. */
11402 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
11403 /* Mark as dead. */
11404 dpyinfo->connection = -1;
11406 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
11407 unblock_input ();
11410 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
11411 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
11413 static struct terminal *
11414 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
11416 struct terminal *terminal;
11418 terminal = create_terminal (output_x_window, &x_redisplay_interface);
11420 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
11421 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
11423 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
11425 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
11426 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
11427 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
11428 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
11429 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
11430 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
11431 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
11432 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
11433 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
11434 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
11435 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
11436 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
11437 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
11438 terminal->menu_show_hook = x_menu_show;
11439 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
11440 terminal->popup_dialog_hook = xw_popup_dialog;
11441 #endif
11442 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
11443 terminal->set_horizontal_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar;
11444 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
11445 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
11446 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
11447 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
11448 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
11449 /* Other hooks are NULL by default. */
11451 return terminal;
11454 static void
11455 x_initialize (void)
11457 baud_rate = 19200;
11459 x_noop_count = 0;
11460 any_help_event_p = false;
11461 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
11463 #ifdef USE_GTK
11464 current_count = -1;
11465 #endif
11467 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11468 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
11470 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11471 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11473 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11475 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11476 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11477 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
11478 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
11479 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
11480 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
11481 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
11483 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
11484 #endif
11486 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11487 #ifndef USE_GTK
11488 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
11489 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
11490 #endif
11491 #endif
11493 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11494 original error handler. */
11495 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11496 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11499 #ifdef USE_GTK
11500 void
11501 init_xterm (void)
11503 /* Emacs can handle only core input events, so make sure
11504 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
11505 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
11507 #endif
11509 void
11510 syms_of_xterm (void)
11512 x_error_message = NULL;
11514 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
11515 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
11517 #ifdef USE_GTK
11518 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
11519 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
11521 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
11522 #endif
11524 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11525 x_use_underline_position_properties,
11526 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11527 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11528 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11529 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
11530 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
11531 sizes. */);
11532 x_use_underline_position_properties = true;
11534 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11535 x_underline_at_descent_line,
11536 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11537 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
11538 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
11539 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
11540 x_underline_at_descent_line = false;
11542 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11543 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
11544 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11545 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11546 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11547 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11548 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11549 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11550 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = false;
11552 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
11553 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
11554 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
11555 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
11556 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
11557 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
11558 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11559 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
11560 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
11561 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11562 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
11563 #elif USE_GTK
11564 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
11565 #else
11566 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
11567 #endif
11568 #else
11569 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
11570 #endif
11572 DEFSYM (Qmodifier_value, "modifier-value");
11573 DEFSYM (Qalt, "alt");
11574 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
11575 DEFSYM (Qhyper, "hyper");
11576 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
11577 DEFSYM (Qmeta, "meta");
11578 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
11579 DEFSYM (Qsuper, "super");
11580 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
11582 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
11583 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11584 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11585 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11586 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11587 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
11589 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
11590 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11591 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11592 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11593 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11594 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
11596 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
11597 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11598 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11599 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11600 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11601 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
11603 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
11604 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11605 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11606 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11607 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11608 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
11610 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
11611 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11612 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
11613 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
11614 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
11615 Qnil);